annotate etc/NEWS @ 89731:e4b184cef172

*** empty log message ***
author Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
date Sat, 24 Jan 2004 09:13:35 +0000
parents d2c6900fc175
children 68c22ea6027c
Ignore whitespace changes - Everywhere: Within whitespace: At end of lines:
rev   line source
51133
8eb2d4a0fe7f *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 51077
diff changeset
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
49407
c47a7a3493da *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49395
diff changeset
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3 See the end for copying conditions.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
6 For older news, see the file ONEWS
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7
41749
83a9052556ea Setting left-fringe and rigth-fringe parameters to nil causes
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 41748
diff changeset
8 Temporary note:
83a9052556ea Setting left-fringe and rigth-fringe parameters to nil causes
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 41748
diff changeset
9 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
83a9052556ea Setting left-fringe and rigth-fringe parameters to nil causes
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 41748
diff changeset
10 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
83a9052556ea Setting left-fringe and rigth-fringe parameters to nil causes
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 41748
diff changeset
11 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
46034
29c0705b3531 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46028
diff changeset
12 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
41749
83a9052556ea Setting left-fringe and rigth-fringe parameters to nil causes
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 41748
diff changeset
13
89502
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
14 Fixme: The notes about Emacs 22 are quite incomplete.
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
15
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
16
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
17 * Changes in Emacs 22.1
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
18
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
19 ** The Emacs character set is now a superset of Unicode.
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
20 (It has about four times the code space, which should be plenty).
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
21
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
22 The internal encoding used for buffers and strings is now
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
23 Unicode-based and called `utf-8-emacs'. utf-8-emacs is backwards
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
24 compatible with the UTF-8 encoding of Unicode. The `emacs-mule'
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
25 coding system can still read and write data in the old internal
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
26 encoding.
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
27
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
28 There are still charsets which contain disjoint sets of characters
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
29 where this is necessary or useful, especially for various Far Eastern
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
30 sets which are problematic with Unicode.
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
31
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
32 Since the internal encoding is also used by default for byte-compiled
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
33 files -- i.e. the normal coding system for byte-compiled Lisp files is
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
34 now utf-8-Emacs -- Lisp containing non-ASCII characters which is
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
35 compiled by Emacs 22 can't be read by earlier versions of Emacs.
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
36 Files compiled by Emacs 20 or 21 are loaded correctly as emacs-mule
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
37 (whether or not they contain multibyte characters), which makes
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
38 loading them somewhat slower than Emacs 22-compiled files. Thus it
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
39 may be worth recompiling existing .elc files which don't need to be
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
40 shared with older Emacsen.
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
41
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
42 ** There are assorted new coding systems/aliases -- see
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
43 M-x list-coding-systems.
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
44
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
45 ** New charset implementation with many new charsets.
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
46 See M-x list-character-sets. New charsets can be defined conveniently
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
47 as tables of unicodes.
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
48
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
49 The dimension of a charset is now 0, 1, 2, or 3, and the size of each
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
50 dimension is no longer limited to 94 or 96.
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
51
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
52 Generic characters no longer exist.
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
53
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
54 A dynamic charset priority list is used to infer the charset of
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
55 unicodes for display &c.
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
56
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
57 ** The following facilities are obsolete:
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
58
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
59 Minor modes: unify-8859-on-encoding-mode, unify-8859-on-decoding-mode
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
60
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
61
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
62 * Lisp changes in Emacs 22.1
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
63
89557
d2c6900fc175 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 89502
diff changeset
64 map-char-table's behaviour has changed.
d2c6900fc175 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 89502
diff changeset
65
89502
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
66 New functions: characterp, max-char, map-charset-chars,
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
67 define-charset-alias, primary-charset, set-primary-charset,
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
68 unify-charset, clear-charset-maps, charset-priority-list,
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
69 set-charset-priority, define-coding-system,
89557
d2c6900fc175 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 89502
diff changeset
70 define-coding-system-alias, coding-system-aliases, langinfo,
d2c6900fc175 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 89502
diff changeset
71 string-to-multibyte.
89502
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
72
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
73 Changed functions: copy-sequence, decode-char, encode-char,
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
74 set-fontset-font, new-fontset, modify-syntax-entry, define-charset,
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
75 modify-category-entry
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
76
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
77 Obsoleted: char-bytes, chars-in-region, set-coding-priority,
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
78 char-valid-p
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
79
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
80
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
81 * Incompatible Lisp changes
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
82
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
83 Deleted functions: make-coding-system, register-char-codings,
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
84 coding-system-spec
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
85
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
86 ** The character codes for characters from the
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
87 eight-bit-control/eight-bit-graphic charsets aren't now in the range
faa5bc8e8516 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 88123
diff changeset
88 128-255.
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
89
44724
867beadfbb38 *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44718
diff changeset
90 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.4
41099
eab977ad2163 Mention installation options --program-prefix, --program-suffix
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 41091
diff changeset
91
49347
4e87b41641d9 Mention Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents: 49341
diff changeset
92 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
51647
c9a97d52236b *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 51608
diff changeset
93 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
c9a97d52236b *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 51608
diff changeset
94 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
49347
4e87b41641d9 Mention Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents: 49341
diff changeset
95
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
96 ---
44431
dbbff2e791e6 Emacs can be built without sound.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 44418
diff changeset
97 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
dbbff2e791e6 Emacs can be built without sound.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 44418
diff changeset
98
47616
fb782cfe9a36 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 47537
diff changeset
99 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with elisp code.
fb782cfe9a36 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 47537
diff changeset
100
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
101 ---
41099
eab977ad2163 Mention installation options --program-prefix, --program-suffix
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 41091
diff changeset
102 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
eab977ad2163 Mention installation options --program-prefix, --program-suffix
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 41091
diff changeset
103 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
eab977ad2163 Mention installation options --program-prefix, --program-suffix
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 41091
diff changeset
104 installed programs.
eab977ad2163 Mention installation options --program-prefix, --program-suffix
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 41091
diff changeset
105
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
106 ---
44822
0ecfbafcac13 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 44724
diff changeset
107 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
44857
59ced914827b *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 44843
diff changeset
108 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
59ced914827b *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 44843
diff changeset
109 place for game scores to be stored. This may be controlled by the
59ced914827b *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 44843
diff changeset
110 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
59ced914827b *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 44843
diff changeset
111 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
44996
dbde822f9021 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 44972
diff changeset
112 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
dbde822f9021 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 44972
diff changeset
113 in each user's home directory.
44822
0ecfbafcac13 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 44724
diff changeset
114
42216
8fc2782f2f8d Document the inclusion of Leim in the standard tarball.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42197
diff changeset
115 ---
8fc2782f2f8d Document the inclusion of Leim in the standard tarball.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42197
diff changeset
116 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
8fc2782f2f8d Document the inclusion of Leim in the standard tarball.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42197
diff changeset
117 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
8fc2782f2f8d Document the inclusion of Leim in the standard tarball.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42197
diff changeset
118 Emacs with Leim.
8fc2782f2f8d Document the inclusion of Leim in the standard tarball.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42197
diff changeset
119
48054
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
120 +++
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
121 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
122
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
123 The ELisp reference manual in Info format is built as part of the
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
124 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
125 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
126 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
127
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
128 ---
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
129 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
130 the distribution.
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
131
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
132 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
133 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
134 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
135 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
136
49549
99be3a1e2589 Cygwin support patch.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 49530
diff changeset
137 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
99be3a1e2589 Cygwin support patch.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 49530
diff changeset
138
42990
94da0e3159a2 Mention support for BSD/OS 5.0.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42984
diff changeset
139 ---
41675
30f353761d6c *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 41623
diff changeset
140 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
30f353761d6c *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 41623
diff changeset
141
42990
94da0e3159a2 Mention support for BSD/OS 5.0.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42984
diff changeset
142 ---
45195
8572b81e3c30 Document support for s390-linux-gnu.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 45119
diff changeset
143 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
8572b81e3c30 Document support for s390-linux-gnu.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 45119
diff changeset
144
8572b81e3c30 Document support for s390-linux-gnu.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 45119
diff changeset
145 ---
44898
457be7d90d62 Document the MacOS X support.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44876
diff changeset
146 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
457be7d90d62 Document the MacOS X support.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44876
diff changeset
147 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
457be7d90d62 Document the MacOS X support.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44876
diff changeset
148
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
149 ---
45667
16708fb2d951 Add Support for x86-64.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents: 45666
diff changeset
150 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
48054
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
151
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
152 ---
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
153 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
41229
70059cb88be4 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41099
diff changeset
154
48027
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
155 ---
48054
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
156 ** A French translation of the Emacs Tutorial is available.
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
157
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
158
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
159 * Changes in Emacs 21.4
48027
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
160
51902
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
161 ** sql changes.
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
162
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
163 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
164 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
165 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
166 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
167 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
168
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
169 The following values are supported:
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
170
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
171 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
172 db2 DB2
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
173 informix Informix
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
174 ingres Ingres
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
175 interbase Interbase
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
176 linter Linter
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
177 ms Microsoft
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
178 mysql MySQL
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
179 oracle Oracle
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
180 postgres Postgres
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
181 solid Solid
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
182 sqlite SQLite
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
183 sybase Sybase
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
184
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
185 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
186 SQL mode indicator.
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
187
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
188 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
189 your .emacs will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
190 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
191
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
192 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
193 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
194 all identifiers ending in "_t" under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
195 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
196
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
197 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
198 '("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face))
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
199
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
200 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i. Most
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
201 SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
202 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
203
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
204 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
205 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
206 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
207 osql flushes it's error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
208 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
209 terminated.
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
210
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
211 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
212 called with the -E command line argument to use the operating system
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
213 credentials to authenticate the user.
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
214
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
215 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
216 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
217 defaults.
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
218
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
219 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
220 appropriate sql-interactive-mode wrapper for the current setting of
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
221 `sql-product'.
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
222
51852
dc926bfd8248 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51831
diff changeset
223 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
dc926bfd8248 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51831
diff changeset
224 with special modes such as Tar mode.
dc926bfd8248 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51831
diff changeset
225
51934
6c938273685a New apropos features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51928
diff changeset
226 ** Enhancements to apropos commands:
6c938273685a New apropos features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51928
diff changeset
227
6c938273685a New apropos features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51928
diff changeset
228 *** The apropos commands will now accept a list of words to match.
6c938273685a New apropos features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51928
diff changeset
229 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
6c938273685a New apropos features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51928
diff changeset
230 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
6c938273685a New apropos features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51928
diff changeset
231 available.
6c938273685a New apropos features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51928
diff changeset
232
6c938273685a New apropos features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51928
diff changeset
233 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
6c938273685a New apropos features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51928
diff changeset
234 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
6c938273685a New apropos features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51928
diff changeset
235 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
6c938273685a New apropos features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51928
diff changeset
236 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
6c938273685a New apropos features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51928
diff changeset
237 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
6c938273685a New apropos features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51928
diff changeset
238 matching item.
51886
8065f7ca3329 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51852
diff changeset
239
51808
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
240 +++
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
241 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
242 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
243 the operating system or your X server.
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
244
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
245 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
51710
28e2763d0439 *** empty log message ***
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 51647
diff changeset
246 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
51902
80522e1627b8 *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51886
diff changeset
247 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
51710
28e2763d0439 *** empty log message ***
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 51647
diff changeset
248
28e2763d0439 *** empty log message ***
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 51647
diff changeset
249 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
28e2763d0439 *** empty log message ***
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 51647
diff changeset
250 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
28e2763d0439 *** empty log message ***
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 51647
diff changeset
251
28e2763d0439 *** empty log message ***
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 51647
diff changeset
252 +++
28e2763d0439 *** empty log message ***
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 51647
diff changeset
253 ** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
28e2763d0439 *** empty log message ***
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 51647
diff changeset
254 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
28e2763d0439 *** empty log message ***
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 51647
diff changeset
255 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
28e2763d0439 *** empty log message ***
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 51647
diff changeset
256
51608
05ddf95bcbff *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51602
diff changeset
257 ** Support for the SQLite interpreter has been added to sql.el by calling
05ddf95bcbff *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51602
diff changeset
258 'sql-sqlite'.
05ddf95bcbff *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51602
diff changeset
259
51505
96facfc71511 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 51374
diff changeset
260 ** BibTeX mode:
96facfc71511 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 51374
diff changeset
261 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
96facfc71511 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 51374
diff changeset
262 *** bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries can take values `plain',
96facfc71511 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 51374
diff changeset
263 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
96facfc71511 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 51374
diff changeset
264 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
51744
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
265 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
266 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
267 bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries is non-nil.
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
268
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
269 *** If the new variable bibtex-parse-keys-fast is non-nil,
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
270 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
271
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
272 *** If the new variable bibtex-autoadd-commas is non-nil,
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
273 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
274
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
275 *** The new variable bibtex-autofill-types contains a list of entry
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
276 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
277
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
278 *** The new command bibtex-complete completes word fragment before
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
279 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
280
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
281 *** The new commands bibtex-find-entry and bibtex-find-crossref
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
282 locate entries and crossref'd entries.
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
283
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
284 *** In BibTeX mode the command fill-paragraph (bound to M-q) fills
31b7c8b5289d Describe bibtex.el changes. From Roland Winkler.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 51715
diff changeset
285 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
51505
96facfc71511 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 51374
diff changeset
286
51215
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
287 ** When display margins are present in a window, the fringes are now
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
288 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
289 at the edges of the window.
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
290
51222
083c1ba5b1d9 Fix typos.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51215
diff changeset
291 ** A window may now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
51215
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
292 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
293
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
294 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
51222
083c1ba5b1d9 Fix typos.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51215
diff changeset
295 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
51215
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
296 or when the frame is resized.
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
297
51182
3dd4104b45b6 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 51133
diff changeset
298 ** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
3dd4104b45b6 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 51133
diff changeset
299
51133
8eb2d4a0fe7f *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 51077
diff changeset
300 ** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which may
8eb2d4a0fe7f *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 51077
diff changeset
301 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
8eb2d4a0fe7f *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 51077
diff changeset
302
51828
94d3cf9e9e14 *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51808
diff changeset
303 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
94d3cf9e9e14 *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51808
diff changeset
304 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
94d3cf9e9e14 *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51808
diff changeset
305
51133
8eb2d4a0fe7f *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 51077
diff changeset
306 ** `describe-char' can show data from the Unicode database file. See
8eb2d4a0fe7f *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 51077
diff changeset
307 user option `unicode-data'.
8eb2d4a0fe7f *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 51077
diff changeset
308
51374
31bb2083978b *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 51300
diff changeset
309 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
50975
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
310
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
311 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
312 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
313
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
314 ** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
315 Emacs will prompt her for confirmation.
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
316
50897
289523dd4fa7 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 50794
diff changeset
317 ** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
289523dd4fa7 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 50794
diff changeset
318
50794
4239cd7727ca Add an entry for GDB-UI.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 50773
diff changeset
319 ** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
4239cd7727ca Add an entry for GDB-UI.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 50773
diff changeset
320 and other common debugger commands.
4239cd7727ca Add an entry for GDB-UI.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 50773
diff changeset
321
50716
bb0aa4c18cfe *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 50710
diff changeset
322 ** recentf changes.
bb0aa4c18cfe *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 50710
diff changeset
323
bb0aa4c18cfe *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 50710
diff changeset
324 The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
bb0aa4c18cfe *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 50710
diff changeset
325 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
bb0aa4c18cfe *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 50710
diff changeset
326 automatic cleanup.
bb0aa4c18cfe *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 50710
diff changeset
327
bb0aa4c18cfe *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 50710
diff changeset
328 With the more advanced option: `recentf-filename-handler', you can
bb0aa4c18cfe *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 50710
diff changeset
329 specify a function that transforms filenames handled by recentf. For
bb0aa4c18cfe *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 50710
diff changeset
330 example, if set to `file-truename', the same file will not be in the
bb0aa4c18cfe *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 50710
diff changeset
331 recent list with different symbolic links.
bb0aa4c18cfe *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 50710
diff changeset
332
bb0aa4c18cfe *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 50710
diff changeset
333 To follow naming convention, `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-flag'
bb0aa4c18cfe *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 50710
diff changeset
334 and `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag' respectively replace the
bb0aa4c18cfe *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 50710
diff changeset
335 misnamed options `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p' and
bb0aa4c18cfe *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 50710
diff changeset
336 `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The old names remain available as
bb0aa4c18cfe *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 50710
diff changeset
337 aliases, but have been marked obsolete.
bb0aa4c18cfe *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 50710
diff changeset
338
49799
8cdcf1a04744 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49766
diff changeset
339 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
8cdcf1a04744 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49766
diff changeset
340 from the locale.
49713
f863aaa8296d *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49668
diff changeset
341
48021
1c7fc6ad1178 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47739
diff changeset
342 ** Init file changes
1c7fc6ad1178 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47739
diff changeset
343
1c7fc6ad1178 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47739
diff changeset
344 You can now put the init files .emacs and .emacs_SHELL under
1c7fc6ad1178 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47739
diff changeset
345 ~/.emacs.d or directly under ~. Emacs will find them in either place.
1c7fc6ad1178 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47739
diff changeset
346
50553
11c29e283064 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50544
diff changeset
347 ** partial-completion-mode now does partial completion on directory names.
11c29e283064 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50544
diff changeset
348
51300
0d8a28231554 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51222
diff changeset
349 ** skeleton.el now supports using - to mark the skeleton-point without
0d8a28231554 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51222
diff changeset
350 interregion interaction. @ has reverted to only setting
0d8a28231554 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51222
diff changeset
351 skeleton-positions and no longer sets skeleton-point. Skeletons
0d8a28231554 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51222
diff changeset
352 which used @ to mark skeleton-point independent of _ should now use -
0d8a28231554 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51222
diff changeset
353 instead. The updated skeleton-insert docstring explains these new
0d8a28231554 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51222
diff changeset
354 features along with other details of skeleton construction.
0d8a28231554 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51222
diff changeset
355
47730
2568d5a27317 Upgraded to mh-e version 6.1.1.
Bill Wohler <wohler@newt.com>
parents: 47650
diff changeset
356 ** MH-E changes.
2568d5a27317 Upgraded to mh-e version 6.1.1.
Bill Wohler <wohler@newt.com>
parents: 47650
diff changeset
357
50702
7dd3d5eae9c7 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.3.
Bill Wohler <wohler@newt.com>
parents: 50607
diff changeset
358 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.3. There have been major changes since
47730
2568d5a27317 Upgraded to mh-e version 6.1.1.
Bill Wohler <wohler@newt.com>
parents: 47650
diff changeset
359 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
2568d5a27317 Upgraded to mh-e version 6.1.1.
Bill Wohler <wohler@newt.com>
parents: 47650
diff changeset
360
45874
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
361 +++
49407
c47a7a3493da *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49395
diff changeset
362 ** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
c47a7a3493da *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49395
diff changeset
363 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given elisp
c47a7a3493da *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49395
diff changeset
364 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
c47a7a3493da *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49395
diff changeset
365
c47a7a3493da *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49395
diff changeset
366 ** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
47650
5dbc6d83f14d Add info about --eval and --display.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 47621
diff changeset
367
5dbc6d83f14d Add info about --eval and --display.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 47621
diff changeset
368 +++
46736
11f94cbe273f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46687
diff changeset
369 ** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
11f94cbe273f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46687
diff changeset
370 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
11f94cbe273f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46687
diff changeset
371 appears between the position information and the major mode.
47085
a881d14145d0 etags now parses HTML.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 47070
diff changeset
372
47201
f17f344680f2 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47172
diff changeset
373 ** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
f17f344680f2 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47172
diff changeset
374 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
f17f344680f2 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47172
diff changeset
375
46736
11f94cbe273f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46687
diff changeset
376 +++
45874
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
377 ** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
378 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
379 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
380 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
381 set-fringe-style.
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
382
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
383 +++
45426
784a17ff4998 Move remarks on `mail-default-directory' down to section
Markus Rost <rost@math.uni-bielefeld.de>
parents: 45425
diff changeset
384 ** There is a new user option `mail-default-directory' that allows you
784a17ff4998 Move remarks on `mail-default-directory' down to section
Markus Rost <rost@math.uni-bielefeld.de>
parents: 45425
diff changeset
385 to specify the value of `default-directory' for mail buffers. This
784a17ff4998 Move remarks on `mail-default-directory' down to section
Markus Rost <rost@math.uni-bielefeld.de>
parents: 45425
diff changeset
386 directory is used for auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to
784a17ff4998 Move remarks on `mail-default-directory' down to section
Markus Rost <rost@math.uni-bielefeld.de>
parents: 45425
diff changeset
387 "~/".
784a17ff4998 Move remarks on `mail-default-directory' down to section
Markus Rost <rost@math.uni-bielefeld.de>
parents: 45425
diff changeset
388
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
389 +++
46201
ec2505a6b272 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46128
diff changeset
390 ** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
ec2505a6b272 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46128
diff changeset
391 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
ec2505a6b272 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46128
diff changeset
392 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you will in fact be able
ec2505a6b272 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46128
diff changeset
393 to alter the file.)
ec2505a6b272 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46128
diff changeset
394
46787
6f3953a83c05 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46775
diff changeset
395 ** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
6f3953a83c05 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46775
diff changeset
396 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
6f3953a83c05 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46775
diff changeset
397
50312
11f0b75d4df1 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 50055
diff changeset
398 ** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
11f0b75d4df1 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 50055
diff changeset
399 of a file.
11f0b75d4df1 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 50055
diff changeset
400
44876
29664616fca1 Add latest new features.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44857
diff changeset
401 ---
49799
8cdcf1a04744 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49766
diff changeset
402 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
45336
a6bd3dde3bfd Document that ps-print can print Unicode characters.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 45302
diff changeset
403
a6bd3dde3bfd Document that ps-print can print Unicode characters.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 45302
diff changeset
404 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
a6bd3dde3bfd Document that ps-print can print Unicode characters.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 45302
diff changeset
405 ps-print, provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF fonts.
a6bd3dde3bfd Document that ps-print can print Unicode characters.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 45302
diff changeset
406 See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
a6bd3dde3bfd Document that ps-print can print Unicode characters.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 45302
diff changeset
407
a6bd3dde3bfd Document that ps-print can print Unicode characters.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 45302
diff changeset
408 ---
44876
29664616fca1 Add latest new features.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44857
diff changeset
409 ** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
29664616fca1 Add latest new features.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44857
diff changeset
410 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
29664616fca1 Add latest new features.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44857
diff changeset
411 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
29664616fca1 Add latest new features.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44857
diff changeset
412
29664616fca1 Add latest new features.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44857
diff changeset
413 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
29664616fca1 Add latest new features.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44857
diff changeset
414 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
29664616fca1 Add latest new features.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44857
diff changeset
415 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories will be
29664616fca1 Add latest new features.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44857
diff changeset
416 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
29664616fca1 Add latest new features.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44857
diff changeset
417 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
29664616fca1 Add latest new features.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44857
diff changeset
418
29664616fca1 Add latest new features.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44857
diff changeset
419 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
29664616fca1 Add latest new features.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44857
diff changeset
420 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
29664616fca1 Add latest new features.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44857
diff changeset
421 t, and the status is shown.
29664616fca1 Add latest new features.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44857
diff changeset
422
29664616fca1 Add latest new features.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44857
diff changeset
423 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
29664616fca1 Add latest new features.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44857
diff changeset
424 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
29664616fca1 Add latest new features.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44857
diff changeset
425
29664616fca1 Add latest new features.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44857
diff changeset
426 +++
44843
4872781b98d4 Customize-face suggesting to customize face under point.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 44827
diff changeset
427 ** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
45874
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
428 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
429 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
430 faces.
44843
4872781b98d4 Customize-face suggesting to customize face under point.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 44827
diff changeset
431
49407
c47a7a3493da *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49395
diff changeset
432 ** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Windows-1251, Tajik,
c47a7a3493da *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49395
diff changeset
433 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
49799
8cdcf1a04744 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49766
diff changeset
434 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
8cdcf1a04744 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49766
diff changeset
435 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
8cdcf1a04744 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49766
diff changeset
436 automatically according to the locale.)
49407
c47a7a3493da *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49395
diff changeset
437
c47a7a3493da *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49395
diff changeset
438 ** Indian support has been updated.
c47a7a3493da *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49395
diff changeset
439 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
c47a7a3493da *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49395
diff changeset
440 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
49799
8cdcf1a04744 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49766
diff changeset
441 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
8cdcf1a04744 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49766
diff changeset
442 supported.
46677
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
443
46936
731e4a095774 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46878
diff changeset
444 ---
46677
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
445 ** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
446 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
447 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
448 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
49799
8cdcf1a04744 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49766
diff changeset
449 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
8cdcf1a04744 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49766
diff changeset
450 tamil-inscript.
46677
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
451
46936
731e4a095774 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46878
diff changeset
452 ---
731e4a095774 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46878
diff changeset
453 ** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
731e4a095774 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46878
diff changeset
454 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
731e4a095774 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46878
diff changeset
455 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
731e4a095774 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46878
diff changeset
456
731e4a095774 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46878
diff changeset
457 ---
46677
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
458 ** Many new coding systems are available by loading the `code-pages'
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
459 library. These include complete versions of most of those in
48770
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
460 codepage.el, based on Unicode mappings.
46677
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
461
50897
289523dd4fa7 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 50794
diff changeset
462 ** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
289523dd4fa7 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 50794
diff changeset
463 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences (mostly representing CJK
289523dd4fa7 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 50794
diff changeset
464 characters) are simply composed into single quasi-characters. User
289523dd4fa7 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 50794
diff changeset
465 option `utf-translate-cjk' arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK
289523dd4fa7 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 50794
diff changeset
466 character sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the
289523dd4fa7 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 50794
diff changeset
467 Mule-UCS system. This uses significant space, so is not the default.
289523dd4fa7 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 50794
diff changeset
468 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
289523dd4fa7 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 50794
diff changeset
469 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
289523dd4fa7 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 50794
diff changeset
470 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
50773
b14367118d5a utf-translate-cjk is now called utf-translate-cjk-mode.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 50716
diff changeset
471 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
50897
289523dd4fa7 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 50794
diff changeset
472 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
48770
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
473
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
474 ** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
475 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
476 fontset appropriately.
46677
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
477
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
478 ** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
48770
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
479 unicode.
46677
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
480
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
481 +++
48770
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
482 ** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
483 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
484 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
485 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
486 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
487 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
488 mule-unicode-... ones.
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
489
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
490 By default this translation will happen automatically on encoding.
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
491 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
492 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
493 possible.
46677
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
494
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
495 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
496 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
497 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
48770
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
498 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
499 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
46677
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
500
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
501 ** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
502 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
503 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
49887
68ca3f7b109d Fix misspelling of utf-fragment-on-decoding.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents: 49883
diff changeset
504 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
44018
9ebe6b2c13f3 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 43973
diff changeset
505
48886
f016200d5069 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 48885
diff changeset
506 ** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
f016200d5069 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 48885
diff changeset
507 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
f016200d5069 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 48885
diff changeset
508 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
f016200d5069 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 48885
diff changeset
509 command.
48885
d5393fb79ea2 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 48849
diff changeset
510
45022
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
511 ---
45874
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
512 ** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
43947
348e264952d1 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 43932
diff changeset
513 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
348e264952d1 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 43932
diff changeset
514 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
348e264952d1 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 43932
diff changeset
515
44694
04976f1e1ec2 Document the addition of `hbar'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44680
diff changeset
516 +++
04976f1e1ec2 Document the addition of `hbar'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44680
diff changeset
517 ** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
04976f1e1ec2 Document the addition of `hbar'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44680
diff changeset
518 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
04976f1e1ec2 Document the addition of `hbar'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44680
diff changeset
519 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
04976f1e1ec2 Document the addition of `hbar'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44680
diff changeset
520 cursor does.
04976f1e1ec2 Document the addition of `hbar'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44680
diff changeset
521
44934
ae16f63fe28f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44898
diff changeset
522 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
ae16f63fe28f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44898
diff changeset
523 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
ae16f63fe28f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44898
diff changeset
524 program files that include other program files.
ae16f63fe28f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44898
diff changeset
525
ae16f63fe28f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44898
diff changeset
526 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
ae16f63fe28f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44898
diff changeset
527 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
ae16f63fe28f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44898
diff changeset
528 in them.
ae16f63fe28f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44898
diff changeset
529
43931
27dac8aa4a17 Document addition of po.el.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43925
diff changeset
530 ---
27dac8aa4a17 Document addition of po.el.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43925
diff changeset
531 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
27dac8aa4a17 Document addition of po.el.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43925
diff changeset
532 when Emacs visits them.
27dac8aa4a17 Document addition of po.el.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43925
diff changeset
533
45022
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
534 ---
43772
c8b075cfe7eb Document enhancements to `mpuz.el'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43754
diff changeset
535 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
c8b075cfe7eb Document enhancements to `mpuz.el'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43754
diff changeset
536
c8b075cfe7eb Document enhancements to `mpuz.el'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43754
diff changeset
537 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
c8b075cfe7eb Document enhancements to `mpuz.el'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43754
diff changeset
538 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
c8b075cfe7eb Document enhancements to `mpuz.el'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43754
diff changeset
539 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
c8b075cfe7eb Document enhancements to `mpuz.el'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43754
diff changeset
540
88123
375f2633d815 New directory
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 52419
diff changeset
541 +++
375f2633d815 New directory
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 52419
diff changeset
542 ** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
375f2633d815 New directory
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 52419
diff changeset
543 now shown as a hollow box or a thin bar. However, you can control how
375f2633d815 New directory
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 52419
diff changeset
544 it blinks off by setting the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
375f2633d815 New directory
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 52419
diff changeset
545
51602
5dccfdd80acb *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 51506
diff changeset
546 ** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
5dccfdd80acb *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 51506
diff changeset
547 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
5dccfdd80acb *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 51506
diff changeset
548 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
5dccfdd80acb *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 51506
diff changeset
549 and use the more appropriately result.
5dccfdd80acb *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 51506
diff changeset
550
43356
ba0eac6c2e94 Mark the new hscroll-related variables as documented in the manual.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43353
diff changeset
551 +++
ba0eac6c2e94 Mark the new hscroll-related variables as documented in the manual.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43353
diff changeset
552 ** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
43666
a84483ed5134 Rename the variables related to automatic horizontal scrolling.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43626
diff changeset
553 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
a84483ed5134 Rename the variables related to automatic horizontal scrolling.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43626
diff changeset
554 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
a84483ed5134 Rename the variables related to automatic horizontal scrolling.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43626
diff changeset
555 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
a84483ed5134 Rename the variables related to automatic horizontal scrolling.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43626
diff changeset
556
a84483ed5134 Rename the variables related to automatic horizontal scrolling.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43626
diff changeset
557 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
a84483ed5134 Rename the variables related to automatic horizontal scrolling.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43626
diff changeset
558 hscrolling will scroll the window when point gets too close to the
a84483ed5134 Rename the variables related to automatic horizontal scrolling.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43626
diff changeset
559 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
a84483ed5134 Rename the variables related to automatic horizontal scrolling.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43626
diff changeset
560 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
a84483ed5134 Rename the variables related to automatic horizontal scrolling.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43626
diff changeset
561 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
a84483ed5134 Rename the variables related to automatic horizontal scrolling.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43626
diff changeset
562 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
a84483ed5134 Rename the variables related to automatic horizontal scrolling.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43626
diff changeset
563
46936
731e4a095774 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46878
diff changeset
564 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
731e4a095774 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46878
diff changeset
565 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
731e4a095774 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46878
diff changeset
566
51505
96facfc71511 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 51374
diff changeset
567 ** TeX modes:
51374
31bb2083978b *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 51300
diff changeset
568 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
45022
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
569 +++
50553
11c29e283064 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50544
diff changeset
570 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
44827
7ced19dba698 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44822
diff changeset
571 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
7ced19dba698 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44822
diff changeset
572 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
7ced19dba698 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44822
diff changeset
573 TeX commands to use at startup.
50553
11c29e283064 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50544
diff changeset
574 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
11c29e283064 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50544
diff changeset
575 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
44827
7ced19dba698 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44822
diff changeset
576
50975
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
577 *** New major mode doctex-mode for *.dtx files.
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
578
43666
a84483ed5134 Rename the variables related to automatic horizontal scrolling.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43626
diff changeset
579 +++
50509
81ee3475a52d *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50474
diff changeset
580 ** New display feature: focus follows the mouse from one Emacs window
81ee3475a52d *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50474
diff changeset
581 to another, even within a frame. If you set the variable
81ee3475a52d *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50474
diff changeset
582 mouse-autoselect-window to non-nil value, moving the mouse to a
81ee3475a52d *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50474
diff changeset
583 different Emacs window will select that window (minibuffer window can
81ee3475a52d *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50474
diff changeset
584 be selected only when it is active). The default is nil, so that this
81ee3475a52d *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50474
diff changeset
585 feature is not enabled.
43345
1230529aa3ae *** empty log message ***
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 43302
diff changeset
586
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
587 +++
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
588 ** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
589 description various information about a character, including its
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
590 encodings and syntax, its text properties, overlays, and widgets at
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
591 point. You can get more information about some of them, by clicking
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
592 on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
43297
48c78f4f57f1 Document describe-text-at.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43263
diff changeset
593
44822
0ecfbafcac13 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 44724
diff changeset
594 +++
0ecfbafcac13 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 44724
diff changeset
595 ** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
0ecfbafcac13 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 44724
diff changeset
596 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
0ecfbafcac13 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 44724
diff changeset
597 `multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
0ecfbafcac13 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 44724
diff changeset
598 buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
0ecfbafcac13 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 44724
diff changeset
599 rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
0ecfbafcac13 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 44724
diff changeset
600
45022
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
601 +++
43433
bacf1b0c4081 Minor cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43415
diff changeset
602 ** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
bacf1b0c4081 Minor cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43415
diff changeset
603 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
bacf1b0c4081 Minor cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43415
diff changeset
604 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
bacf1b0c4081 Minor cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43415
diff changeset
605 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
bacf1b0c4081 Minor cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43415
diff changeset
606 also disable mouse highlighting.
43375
7370da6d0364 Document new mouse-highlight variable and associated behaviour.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43356
diff changeset
607
45022
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
608 +++
43238
14e305b050b5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 43217
diff changeset
609 ** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
14e305b050b5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 43217
diff changeset
610 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
14e305b050b5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 43217
diff changeset
611 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
14e305b050b5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 43217
diff changeset
612 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
14e305b050b5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 43217
diff changeset
613 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
14e305b050b5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 43217
diff changeset
614
43100
b31f95ef830a Document the minibuffer-prompt face.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43061
diff changeset
615 +++
b31f95ef830a Document the minibuffer-prompt face.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43061
diff changeset
616 ** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
b31f95ef830a Document the minibuffer-prompt face.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43061
diff changeset
617 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
b31f95ef830a Document the minibuffer-prompt face.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43061
diff changeset
618 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
b31f95ef830a Document the minibuffer-prompt face.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43061
diff changeset
619 prompt string.
b31f95ef830a Document the minibuffer-prompt face.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43061
diff changeset
620
43263
6862a1a4bd8e *** empty log message ***
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43245
diff changeset
621 +++
43206
cc9c8c17538f Describe new mode-line-inactive face.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43196
diff changeset
622 ** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
cc9c8c17538f Describe new mode-line-inactive face.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43196
diff changeset
623 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
cc9c8c17538f Describe new mode-line-inactive face.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43196
diff changeset
624 the mode line of the currently selected window.
cc9c8c17538f Describe new mode-line-inactive face.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43196
diff changeset
625
43245
6a3915789e36 Describe mode-line-in-non-selected-windows variable.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43238
diff changeset
626 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
6a3915789e36 Describe mode-line-in-non-selected-windows variable.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43238
diff changeset
627 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
6a3915789e36 Describe mode-line-in-non-selected-windows variable.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43238
diff changeset
628
45874
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
629 ---
43008
970e7e00f09a Mention "Show/Hide" menu.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 43001
diff changeset
630 ** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
45874
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
631 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
632 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
633 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
634 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
635 current date and time, current line and column number in the
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
636 mode-line.
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
637
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
638 ---
43383
d21a74d23497 2002-02-17 Per Abrahamsen <abraham@dina.kvl.dk>
Per Abrahamsen <abraham@dina.kvl.dk>
parents: 43375
diff changeset
639 ** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
d21a74d23497 2002-02-17 Per Abrahamsen <abraham@dina.kvl.dk>
Per Abrahamsen <abraham@dina.kvl.dk>
parents: 43375
diff changeset
640
45022
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
641 +++
50897
289523dd4fa7 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 50794
diff changeset
642 ** Emacs can now indicate in the mode-line the presence of new e-mail
45022
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
643 in a directory or in a file. See the documentation of the user option
43009
a3b76a4ebe1c *** empty log message ***
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 43008
diff changeset
644 `display-time-mail-directory'.
43001
eb883dc8e44a display-time can now incicate new e-mail in directory.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 42990
diff changeset
645
42822
b2bfe0b4018b Advertise Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42820
diff changeset
646 +++
51928
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
647 ** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
42822
b2bfe0b4018b Advertise Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42820
diff changeset
648
42786
66b0f6a32c47 LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 42749
diff changeset
649 ---
66b0f6a32c47 LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 42749
diff changeset
650 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
66b0f6a32c47 LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 42749
diff changeset
651
43045
39d6853f817c Mark the pc-selection-mode change as documented.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43043
diff changeset
652 +++
43043
98b7448c1aac *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43009
diff changeset
653 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
43045
39d6853f817c Mark the pc-selection-mode change as documented.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43043
diff changeset
654 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
43043
98b7448c1aac *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43009
diff changeset
655 argument it toggles the mode.
98b7448c1aac *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43009
diff changeset
656
98b7448c1aac *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43009
diff changeset
657 Turning off PC-Selection mode restores the global key bindings
98b7448c1aac *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43009
diff changeset
658 that were replaced by turning on the mode.
98b7448c1aac *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43009
diff changeset
659
45874
5cce53a1bf6f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45859
diff changeset
660 +++
45565
c3aabeb6a3af *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45547
diff changeset
661 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
c3aabeb6a3af *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45547
diff changeset
662 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
c3aabeb6a3af *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45547
diff changeset
663 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
c3aabeb6a3af *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45547
diff changeset
664 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
c3aabeb6a3af *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45547
diff changeset
665 `inhibit-splash-screen').
c3aabeb6a3af *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45547
diff changeset
666
42958
2d81f84af342 Document the extended color support for xterm and rxvt, and the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42940
diff changeset
667 ** Changes in support of colors on character terminals
2d81f84af342 Document the extended color support for xterm and rxvt, and the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42940
diff changeset
668
42729
5814fed2f430 Document the new full-screen options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42725
diff changeset
669 +++
42958
2d81f84af342 Document the extended color support for xterm and rxvt, and the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42940
diff changeset
670 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
42749
62c6ce7088f2 Document the new --color arg and tty-color-mode frame parameter.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42739
diff changeset
671 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
62c6ce7088f2 Document the new --color arg and tty-color-mode frame parameter.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42739
diff changeset
672 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
62c6ce7088f2 Document the new --color arg and tty-color-mode frame parameter.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42739
diff changeset
673 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
62c6ce7088f2 Document the new --color arg and tty-color-mode frame parameter.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42739
diff changeset
674 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
62c6ce7088f2 Document the new --color arg and tty-color-mode frame parameter.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42739
diff changeset
675 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
62c6ce7088f2 Document the new --color arg and tty-color-mode frame parameter.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42739
diff changeset
676 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
62c6ce7088f2 Document the new --color arg and tty-color-mode frame parameter.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42739
diff changeset
677 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
62c6ce7088f2 Document the new --color arg and tty-color-mode frame parameter.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42739
diff changeset
678 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
62c6ce7088f2 Document the new --color arg and tty-color-mode frame parameter.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42739
diff changeset
679
42958
2d81f84af342 Document the extended color support for xterm and rxvt, and the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42940
diff changeset
680 ---
2d81f84af342 Document the extended color support for xterm and rxvt, and the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42940
diff changeset
681 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
2d81f84af342 Document the extended color support for xterm and rxvt, and the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42940
diff changeset
682 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
2d81f84af342 Document the extended color support for xterm and rxvt, and the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42940
diff changeset
683 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
2d81f84af342 Document the extended color support for xterm and rxvt, and the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42940
diff changeset
684 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
2d81f84af342 Document the extended color support for xterm and rxvt, and the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42940
diff changeset
685 all of these colors.
2d81f84af342 Document the extended color support for xterm and rxvt, and the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42940
diff changeset
686
2d81f84af342 Document the extended color support for xterm and rxvt, and the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42940
diff changeset
687 ---
2d81f84af342 Document the extended color support for xterm and rxvt, and the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42940
diff changeset
688 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
2d81f84af342 Document the extended color support for xterm and rxvt, and the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42940
diff changeset
689
42749
62c6ce7088f2 Document the new --color arg and tty-color-mode frame parameter.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42739
diff changeset
690 +++
42729
5814fed2f430 Document the new full-screen options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42725
diff changeset
691 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
5814fed2f430 Document the new full-screen options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42725
diff changeset
692
5814fed2f430 Document the new full-screen options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42725
diff changeset
693 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
5814fed2f430 Document the new full-screen options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42725
diff changeset
694 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
5814fed2f430 Document the new full-screen options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42725
diff changeset
695 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
45119
bb7bdd25e045 --fullscreen options supported on Windows too
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 45022
diff changeset
696 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
42729
5814fed2f430 Document the new full-screen options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42725
diff changeset
697
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
698 ---
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
699 ** Info-index offers completion.
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
700
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
701 ---
45694
b31ffbdd8d11 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45692
diff changeset
702 ** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
703 automatically.
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
704
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
705 +++
49658
b4b0014862b1 Fix misspelling of `comint-insert-previous-argument'.
John Paul Wallington <jpw@pobox.com>
parents: 49657
diff changeset
706 ** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
44622
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
707 modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
708 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
709 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
710
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
711 +++
42739
f53ba4c83bf8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42729
diff changeset
712 ** Changes in C-h bindings:
f53ba4c83bf8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42729
diff changeset
713
f53ba4c83bf8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42729
diff changeset
714 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
f53ba4c83bf8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42729
diff changeset
715
f53ba4c83bf8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42729
diff changeset
716 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
f53ba4c83bf8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42729
diff changeset
717 that do not change:
f53ba4c83bf8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42729
diff changeset
718
f53ba4c83bf8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42729
diff changeset
719 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
f53ba4c83bf8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42729
diff changeset
720 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
f53ba4c83bf8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42729
diff changeset
721
f53ba4c83bf8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42729
diff changeset
722 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
f53ba4c83bf8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42729
diff changeset
723 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
f53ba4c83bf8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42729
diff changeset
724
43159
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
725 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
726
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
727 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
728 run by the key sequence.
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
729
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
730 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
731 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
732 that command.
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
733
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
734 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
43724
16affaf7292b etags honours #line directives.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 43666
diff changeset
735 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
43159
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
736
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
737 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
738 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
739
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
740 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
741 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
742
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
743 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
744 new-kill-line is on C-k
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
745
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
746 +++
41928
31fb6b379d0f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 41923
diff changeset
747 ** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
31fb6b379d0f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 41923
diff changeset
748 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
31fb6b379d0f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 41923
diff changeset
749 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
31fb6b379d0f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 41923
diff changeset
750 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
31fb6b379d0f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 41923
diff changeset
751
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
752 +++
44680
39c7ce6f26c1 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44666
diff changeset
753 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
39c7ce6f26c1 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44666
diff changeset
754 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
39c7ce6f26c1 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44666
diff changeset
755 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
39c7ce6f26c1 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44666
diff changeset
756 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
39c7ce6f26c1 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44666
diff changeset
757
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
758 +++
45565
c3aabeb6a3af *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45547
diff changeset
759 ** Occur, Info, and comint-derived modes now support using
c3aabeb6a3af *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45547
diff changeset
760 M-x font-lock-mode to toggle fontification. The variable
c3aabeb6a3af *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45547
diff changeset
761 `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable fontification,
c3aabeb6a3af *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45547
diff changeset
762 remove `turn-on-font-lock' from `Info-mode-hook'.
c3aabeb6a3af *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45547
diff changeset
763
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
764 +++
44622
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
765 ** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
766 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep will automatically
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
767 detect whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
768 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
769 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
770 command lines to be used than was possible before.
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
771
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
772 ---
44622
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
773 ** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
774 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
775 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
776 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
777 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
778 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
779 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
780
47537
b7761880867f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47506
diff changeset
781 +++
47506
7281e0917f10 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47485
diff changeset
782 ** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
7281e0917f10 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47485
diff changeset
783 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
7281e0917f10 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47485
diff changeset
784 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
7281e0917f10 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47485
diff changeset
785 under the "[State]" button.
7281e0917f10 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47485
diff changeset
786
48735
f5f4f758df8e New customization type `float'.
Markus Rost <rost@math.uni-bielefeld.de>
parents: 48728
diff changeset
787 ** The new customization type `float' specifies numbers with floating
f5f4f758df8e New customization type `float'.
Markus Rost <rost@math.uni-bielefeld.de>
parents: 48728
diff changeset
788 point (no integers are allowed).
f5f4f758df8e New customization type `float'.
Markus Rost <rost@math.uni-bielefeld.de>
parents: 48728
diff changeset
789
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
790 +++
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
791 ** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
41923
86ecd07d46fb *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 41847
diff changeset
792 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
86ecd07d46fb *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 41847
diff changeset
793
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
794 ---
42874
95d25103a45e *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42867
diff changeset
795 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
42830
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
796
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
797 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
798 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
799 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
800 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
801 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
802
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
803 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
804 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
805 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
806 (gud-finish).
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
807
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
808 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
809 (Java 1.1 jdb).
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
810
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
811 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
812 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
813 Set gud-jdb-use-classpath to nil.
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
814
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
815 Added Customization Variables
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
816
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
817 *** gud-jdb-command-name. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
818
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
819 *** gud-jdb-use-classpath. Allows selection of java source file searching
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
820 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan gud-jdb-directories for
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
821 java sources (previous method).
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
822
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
823 *** gud-jdb-directories. List of directories to scan and search for java
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
824 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if gud-jdb-use-classpath
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
825 is nil).
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
826
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
827 Minor Improvements
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
828
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
829 *** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
20fac7788e1f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42822
diff changeset
830
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
831 +++
41620
d5ea676e4052 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41596
diff changeset
832 ** hide-ifdef-mode now uses overlays rather than selective-display
d5ea676e4052 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41596
diff changeset
833 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
d5ea676e4052 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41596
diff changeset
834 changes the behavior of motion commands line C-e and C-p.
d5ea676e4052 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41596
diff changeset
835
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
836 +++
42677
449f96bbb6d0 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42629
diff changeset
837 ** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
449f96bbb6d0 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42629
diff changeset
838 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
449f96bbb6d0 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42629
diff changeset
839 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
42678
3e3348e192cf *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42677
diff changeset
840 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
42681
b683f98f263a *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42678
diff changeset
841 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
42678
3e3348e192cf *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42677
diff changeset
842 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
42677
449f96bbb6d0 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42629
diff changeset
843
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
844 +++
44477
5bcb255d9dc5 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44431
diff changeset
845 ** Dired's v command now runs external viewers to view certain
5bcb255d9dc5 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44431
diff changeset
846 types of files. The variable `dired-view-command-alist' controls
5bcb255d9dc5 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44431
diff changeset
847 what external viewers to use and when.
5bcb255d9dc5 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44431
diff changeset
848
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
849 +++
41596
3c035e37d086 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41594
diff changeset
850 ** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
3c035e37d086 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41594
diff changeset
851 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
3c035e37d086 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41594
diff changeset
852 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
3c035e37d086 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41594
diff changeset
853 is only rarely needed.
3c035e37d086 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41594
diff changeset
854
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
855 ---
41337
3a8e8dd8a64e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41298
diff changeset
856 ** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
41501
994a9d1eee71 Minor change of wording in the documentation of jit-lock-defer-time.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 41482
diff changeset
857
994a9d1eee71 Minor change of wording in the documentation of jit-lock-defer-time.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 41482
diff changeset
858 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
42183
ccf68d58861d Fix typos. From Juanma Barranquero <lektu@teleline.es>.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 42160
diff changeset
859 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
41501
994a9d1eee71 Minor change of wording in the documentation of jit-lock-defer-time.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 41482
diff changeset
860 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
994a9d1eee71 Minor change of wording in the documentation of jit-lock-defer-time.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 41482
diff changeset
861 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
41337
3a8e8dd8a64e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41298
diff changeset
862
43301
898b4b31410f * lisp/simple.el (mark-word): Mark more if repeated.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 43297
diff changeset
863 +++
898b4b31410f * lisp/simple.el (mark-word): Mark more if repeated.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 43297
diff changeset
864 ** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times. If
898b4b31410f * lisp/simple.el (mark-word): Mark more if repeated.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 43297
diff changeset
865 you hit M-C-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h (mark-paragraph), or
898b4b31410f * lisp/simple.el (mark-word): Mark more if repeated.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 43297
diff changeset
866 C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region will now be extended
898b4b31410f * lisp/simple.el (mark-word): Mark more if repeated.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 43297
diff changeset
867 each time, so you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC M-C-SPC,
898b4b31410f * lisp/simple.el (mark-word): Mark more if repeated.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 43297
diff changeset
868 for example. This feature also works for mark-end-of-sentence, if you
898b4b31410f * lisp/simple.el (mark-word): Mark more if repeated.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 43297
diff changeset
869 bind that to a key.
41298
dd0332958888 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41246
diff changeset
870
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
871 +++
44655
13e9258cbefb *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44625
diff changeset
872 ** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
13e9258cbefb *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44625
diff changeset
873 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
13e9258cbefb *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44625
diff changeset
874 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
13e9258cbefb *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44625
diff changeset
875 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
876 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
877 command only.
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
878
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
879 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
880 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
881 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
882 mark or the region.
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
883
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
884 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
885 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
886 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
887 C-g.
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
888
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
889 +++
44589
cff126affe7f Enhancements to set-mark-command and exchange-point-and-mark.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44477
diff changeset
890 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
cff126affe7f Enhancements to set-mark-command and exchange-point-and-mark.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44477
diff changeset
891 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... will cycle through the
cff126affe7f Enhancements to set-mark-command and exchange-point-and-mark.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44477
diff changeset
892 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
cff126affe7f Enhancements to set-mark-command and exchange-point-and-mark.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44477
diff changeset
893
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
894 +++
42605
32e40100d0de *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42487
diff changeset
895 ** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
32e40100d0de *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42487
diff changeset
896 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
32e40100d0de *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42487
diff changeset
897 switching to it.
42299
4bc3e5620674 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42281
diff changeset
898
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
899 +++
42299
4bc3e5620674 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42281
diff changeset
900 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
4bc3e5620674 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42281
diff changeset
901 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
4bc3e5620674 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42281
diff changeset
902 affects the initial frame.
4bc3e5620674 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42281
diff changeset
903
41746
6d817b78bf33 Document prefix arg for M-h.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 41730
diff changeset
904 +++
42183
ccf68d58861d Fix typos. From Juanma Barranquero <lektu@teleline.es>.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 42160
diff changeset
905 ** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
ccf68d58861d Fix typos. From Juanma Barranquero <lektu@teleline.es>.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 42160
diff changeset
906 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
41748
0302528bddbc Fix wording of the last change.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 41746
diff changeset
907 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
0302528bddbc Fix wording of the last change.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 41746
diff changeset
908 paragraphs.
41746
6d817b78bf33 Document prefix arg for M-h.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 41730
diff changeset
909
42101
66b4582e344c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42043
diff changeset
910 ** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
66b4582e344c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42043
diff changeset
911 into the kill ring.
66b4582e344c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42043
diff changeset
912
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
913 +++
42160
530136f9f1b9 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42101
diff changeset
914 ** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
530136f9f1b9 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42101
diff changeset
915 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
530136f9f1b9 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42101
diff changeset
916 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
530136f9f1b9 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42101
diff changeset
917 directory listing into a buffer.
530136f9f1b9 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42101
diff changeset
918
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
919 ---
41298
dd0332958888 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41246
diff changeset
920 ** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
dd0332958888 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41246
diff changeset
921 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
dd0332958888 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41246
diff changeset
922
48575
691ba5e96011 mwheel.el change.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48501
diff changeset
923 ** Unexpected yanking of text due to accidental clicking on the mouse
691ba5e96011 mwheel.el change.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48501
diff changeset
924 wheel button (typically mouse-2) during wheel scrolling is now avoided.
691ba5e96011 mwheel.el change.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48501
diff changeset
925 This behaviour can be customized via the mouse-wheel-click-event and
691ba5e96011 mwheel.el change.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48501
diff changeset
926 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
691ba5e96011 mwheel.el change.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48501
diff changeset
927
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
928 +++
48899
d684f5bc91b8 keyboard-coding-system, optimize-char-coding-system-table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48886
diff changeset
929 ** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
d684f5bc91b8 keyboard-coding-system, optimize-char-coding-system-table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48886
diff changeset
930 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
d684f5bc91b8 keyboard-coding-system, optimize-char-coding-system-table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48886
diff changeset
931 may mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
d684f5bc91b8 keyboard-coding-system, optimize-char-coding-system-table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48886
diff changeset
932 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
d684f5bc91b8 keyboard-coding-system, optimize-char-coding-system-table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48886
diff changeset
933 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
d684f5bc91b8 keyboard-coding-system, optimize-char-coding-system-table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48886
diff changeset
934 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
d684f5bc91b8 keyboard-coding-system, optimize-char-coding-system-table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48886
diff changeset
935 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
d684f5bc91b8 keyboard-coding-system, optimize-char-coding-system-table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48886
diff changeset
936 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
41229
70059cb88be4 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41099
diff changeset
937
40916
4a749a84888c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40889
diff changeset
938 +++
4a749a84888c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40889
diff changeset
939 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
41816
51c83c94195a Fix wording of the save-abbrevs feature; from RMS.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 41756
diff changeset
940 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
51c83c94195a Fix wording of the save-abbrevs feature; from RMS.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 41756
diff changeset
941 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
51c83c94195a Fix wording of the save-abbrevs feature; from RMS.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 41756
diff changeset
942 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
41820
18047a55e5c7 *** empty log message ***
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 41816
diff changeset
943 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
40916
4a749a84888c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40889
diff changeset
944
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
945 +++
40729
650fb912b343 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40686
diff changeset
946 ** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
650fb912b343 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40686
diff changeset
947 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
650fb912b343 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40686
diff changeset
948 appears in.
39552
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
949
47172
dfcd4fdf6fb0 cursor-in-non-selected-windows can now be any cursor type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47158
diff changeset
950 ** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
dfcd4fdf6fb0 cursor-in-non-selected-windows can now be any cursor type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47158
diff changeset
951 of the recognized cursor types.
49549
99be3a1e2589 Cygwin support patch.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 49530
diff changeset
952
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
953 ---
44718
e1f429a4cfd7 Variable auto-save-file-name-transforms now has a third element.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents: 44694
diff changeset
954 ** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
e1f429a4cfd7 Variable auto-save-file-name-transforms now has a third element.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents: 44694
diff changeset
955 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
e1f429a4cfd7 Variable auto-save-file-name-transforms now has a third element.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents: 44694
diff changeset
956 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
e1f429a4cfd7 Variable auto-save-file-name-transforms now has a third element.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents: 44694
diff changeset
957
46736
11f94cbe273f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46687
diff changeset
958 +++
11f94cbe273f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46687
diff changeset
959 ** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
11f94cbe273f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46687
diff changeset
960 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
11f94cbe273f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46687
diff changeset
961 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic' now take an optional parameter MARK,
11f94cbe273f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46687
diff changeset
962 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
11f94cbe273f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46687
diff changeset
963 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
11f94cbe273f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46687
diff changeset
964 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
11f94cbe273f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46687
diff changeset
965 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
11f94cbe273f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46687
diff changeset
966 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
11f94cbe273f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46687
diff changeset
967 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
11f94cbe273f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46687
diff changeset
968
44199
c157bec8fb40 Add section for VC Changes. New entry for `vc-cvs-global-switches'.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 44160
diff changeset
969 ** VC Changes
c157bec8fb40 Add section for VC Changes. New entry for `vc-cvs-global-switches'.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 44160
diff changeset
970
46456
af0b2d3d6ef8 Add entry for C-x C-q.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 46401
diff changeset
971 *** The key C-x C-q no longer checks files in or out, it only changes
af0b2d3d6ef8 Add entry for C-x C-q.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 46401
diff changeset
972 the read-only state of the buffer (toggle-read-only). We made this
af0b2d3d6ef8 Add entry for C-x C-q.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 46401
diff changeset
973 change because we held a poll and found that many users were unhappy
af0b2d3d6ef8 Add entry for C-x C-q.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 46401
diff changeset
974 with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this behavior, you
af0b2d3d6ef8 Add entry for C-x C-q.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 46401
diff changeset
975 can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your .emacs:
af0b2d3d6ef8 Add entry for C-x C-q.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 46401
diff changeset
976
af0b2d3d6ef8 Add entry for C-x C-q.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 46401
diff changeset
977 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
af0b2d3d6ef8 Add entry for C-x C-q.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 46401
diff changeset
978
af0b2d3d6ef8 Add entry for C-x C-q.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 46401
diff changeset
979 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
af0b2d3d6ef8 Add entry for C-x C-q.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 46401
diff changeset
980
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
981 +++
44199
c157bec8fb40 Add section for VC Changes. New entry for `vc-cvs-global-switches'.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 44160
diff changeset
982 *** There is a new user option `vc-cvs-global-switches' that allows
c157bec8fb40 Add section for VC Changes. New entry for `vc-cvs-global-switches'.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 44160
diff changeset
983 you to specify switches that are passed to any CVS command invoked
c157bec8fb40 Add section for VC Changes. New entry for `vc-cvs-global-switches'.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 44160
diff changeset
984 by VC. These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which
c157bec8fb40 Add section for VC Changes. New entry for `vc-cvs-global-switches'.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 44160
diff changeset
985 means they are inserted before the command name. For example, this
c157bec8fb40 Add section for VC Changes. New entry for `vc-cvs-global-switches'.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 44160
diff changeset
986 allows you to specify a compression level using the "-z#" option for
c157bec8fb40 Add section for VC Changes. New entry for `vc-cvs-global-switches'.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 44160
diff changeset
987 CVS.
c157bec8fb40 Add section for VC Changes. New entry for `vc-cvs-global-switches'.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 44160
diff changeset
988
50975
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
989 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
990
44030
67ba867f0082 added a description of the new features in Ediff
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 44018
diff changeset
991 ** EDiff changes.
67ba867f0082 added a description of the new features in Ediff
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 44018
diff changeset
992
44058
b52e085be218 added +++'s
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 44030
diff changeset
993 +++
44030
67ba867f0082 added a description of the new features in Ediff
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 44018
diff changeset
994 *** When comparing directories.
67ba867f0082 added a description of the new features in Ediff
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 44018
diff changeset
995 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
67ba867f0082 added a description of the new features in Ediff
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 44018
diff changeset
996 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
67ba867f0082 added a description of the new features in Ediff
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 44018
diff changeset
997 from one directory to another.
67ba867f0082 added a description of the new features in Ediff
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 44018
diff changeset
998
44058
b52e085be218 added +++'s
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 44030
diff changeset
999 +++
44030
67ba867f0082 added a description of the new features in Ediff
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 44018
diff changeset
1000 *** When comparing files or buffers.
67ba867f0082 added a description of the new features in Ediff
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 44018
diff changeset
1001 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
67ba867f0082 added a description of the new features in Ediff
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 44018
diff changeset
1002 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
67ba867f0082 added a description of the new features in Ediff
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 44018
diff changeset
1003 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
67ba867f0082 added a description of the new features in Ediff
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 44018
diff changeset
1004 comparison.
67ba867f0082 added a description of the new features in Ediff
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 44018
diff changeset
1005
48736
5fc281abe34e Increase outline level of description `ediff-backup' by one *.
Markus Rost <rost@math.uni-bielefeld.de>
parents: 48735
diff changeset
1006 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
46936
731e4a095774 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46878
diff changeset
1007 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
731e4a095774 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46878
diff changeset
1008 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
731e4a095774 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46878
diff changeset
1009
46028
278093843f21 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45997
diff changeset
1010 +++
42043
0fe5fe39786c Etags changes for Prolog and PHP.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 41928
diff changeset
1011 ** Etags changes.
0fe5fe39786c Etags changes for Prolog and PHP.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 41928
diff changeset
1012
45828
ad50e4ff5888 Structure the changes for etags using outline headers.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45802
diff changeset
1013 *** New regular expressions features
ad50e4ff5888 Structure the changes for etags using outline headers.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45802
diff changeset
1014
ad50e4ff5888 Structure the changes for etags using outline headers.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45802
diff changeset
1015 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
45802
d4c9f3bd6dfa New {language} and @regexp features.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45800
diff changeset
1016 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
d4c9f3bd6dfa New {language} and @regexp features.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45800
diff changeset
1017 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
d4c9f3bd6dfa New {language} and @regexp features.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45800
diff changeset
1018 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
d4c9f3bd6dfa New {language} and @regexp features.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45800
diff changeset
1019 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
d4c9f3bd6dfa New {language} and @regexp features.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45800
diff changeset
1020 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
45800
d11816fe2c59 New multi-line regexp and new regexp syntax.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45758
diff changeset
1021 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
d11816fe2c59 New multi-line regexp and new regexp syntax.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45758
diff changeset
1022 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
d11816fe2c59 New multi-line regexp and new regexp syntax.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45758
diff changeset
1023 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
d11816fe2c59 New multi-line regexp and new regexp syntax.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45758
diff changeset
1024 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
d11816fe2c59 New multi-line regexp and new regexp syntax.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45758
diff changeset
1025 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
d11816fe2c59 New multi-line regexp and new regexp syntax.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45758
diff changeset
1026
47085
a881d14145d0 etags now parses HTML.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 47070
diff changeset
1027 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in Gcc.
45800
d11816fe2c59 New multi-line regexp and new regexp syntax.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45758
diff changeset
1028 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
d11816fe2c59 New multi-line regexp and new regexp syntax.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45758
diff changeset
1029 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
d11816fe2c59 New multi-line regexp and new regexp syntax.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45758
diff changeset
1030 CR, TAB, VT,
d11816fe2c59 New multi-line regexp and new regexp syntax.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45758
diff changeset
1031
47085
a881d14145d0 etags now parses HTML.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 47070
diff changeset
1032 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
45802
d4c9f3bd6dfa New {language} and @regexp features.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45800
diff changeset
1033 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
d4c9f3bd6dfa New {language} and @regexp features.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45800
diff changeset
1034 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
d4c9f3bd6dfa New {language} and @regexp features.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45800
diff changeset
1035 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
d4c9f3bd6dfa New {language} and @regexp features.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45800
diff changeset
1036
47085
a881d14145d0 etags now parses HTML.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 47070
diff changeset
1037 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
45802
d4c9f3bd6dfa New {language} and @regexp features.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45800
diff changeset
1038 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
d4c9f3bd6dfa New {language} and @regexp features.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45800
diff changeset
1039 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
d4c9f3bd6dfa New {language} and @regexp features.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45800
diff changeset
1040
45828
ad50e4ff5888 Structure the changes for etags using outline headers.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45802
diff changeset
1041 *** New language parsing features
ad50e4ff5888 Structure the changes for etags using outline headers.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45802
diff changeset
1042
47158
6ec82a0927f2 Etags improvement.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 47096
diff changeset
1043 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
6ec82a0927f2 Etags improvement.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 47096
diff changeset
1044 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
6ec82a0927f2 Etags improvement.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 47096
diff changeset
1045
45828
ad50e4ff5888 Structure the changes for etags using outline headers.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45802
diff changeset
1046 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
43855
db463e67459c Better description of what etags does with #line.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 43772
diff changeset
1047 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
db463e67459c Better description of what etags does with #line.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 43772
diff changeset
1048 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
db463e67459c Better description of what etags does with #line.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 43772
diff changeset
1049 package::sub.
db463e67459c Better description of what etags does with #line.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 43772
diff changeset
1050
47085
a881d14145d0 etags now parses HTML.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 47070
diff changeset
1051 **** New language PHP.
a881d14145d0 etags now parses HTML.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 47070
diff changeset
1052 Tags are functions, classes and defines.
45919
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45901
diff changeset
1053 If the --members option is specified to etags, tags are vars also.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45901
diff changeset
1054
47085
a881d14145d0 etags now parses HTML.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 47070
diff changeset
1055 **** New language HTML.
a881d14145d0 etags now parses HTML.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 47070
diff changeset
1056 Title and h1, h2, h3 are tagged. Also, tags are generated when name= is
a881d14145d0 etags now parses HTML.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 47070
diff changeset
1057 used inside an anchor and whenever id= is used.
a881d14145d0 etags now parses HTML.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 47070
diff changeset
1058
45828
ad50e4ff5888 Structure the changes for etags using outline headers.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45802
diff changeset
1059 **** New default keywords for TeX.
45661
a47ac7311101 Document new default keywords for TeX.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45660
diff changeset
1060 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
a47ac7311101 Document new default keywords for TeX.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45660
diff changeset
1061 renewenvironment.
a47ac7311101 Document new default keywords for TeX.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45660
diff changeset
1062
47085
a881d14145d0 etags now parses HTML.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 47070
diff changeset
1063 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
46989
eeab5bdaffa2 Fix typos.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46962
diff changeset
1064 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
45919
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45901
diff changeset
1065 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45901
diff changeset
1066
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45901
diff changeset
1067 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
43855
db463e67459c Better description of what etags does with #line.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 43772
diff changeset
1068
db463e67459c Better description of what etags does with #line.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 43772
diff changeset
1069 *** Honour #line directives.
db463e67459c Better description of what etags does with #line.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 43772
diff changeset
1070 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
db463e67459c Better description of what etags does with #line.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 43772
diff changeset
1071 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
db463e67459c Better description of what etags does with #line.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 43772
diff changeset
1072 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
db463e67459c Better description of what etags does with #line.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 43772
diff changeset
1073 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
db463e67459c Better description of what etags does with #line.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 43772
diff changeset
1074 writes tags pointing to the source file.
43724
16affaf7292b etags honours #line directives.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 43666
diff changeset
1075
47085
a881d14145d0 etags now parses HTML.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 47070
diff changeset
1076 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
45661
a47ac7311101 Document new default keywords for TeX.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45660
diff changeset
1077 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
45660
cfab79b5f578 Better English, I hope.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45657
diff changeset
1078 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
45661
a47ac7311101 Document new default keywords for TeX.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45660
diff changeset
1079 will read from standard input and mark the produced tags as belonging to
a47ac7311101 Document new default keywords for TeX.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45660
diff changeset
1080 the file FILE.
45657
77cb605109fc Document --parse-stdin=FILE for Etags.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 45614
diff changeset
1081
40493
94818b20da05 Document the change in list-buffers-noselect wrt buffers visiting files
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 40487
diff changeset
1082 +++
51715
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1083 ** CC Mode changes.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1084
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1085 *** Font lock support.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1086 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1087 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1088 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1089 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1090 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1091 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1092
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1093 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1094 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1095 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1096 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1097 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1098 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1099 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1100 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1101 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1102
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1103 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1104 fontification in mind, i.e. there should be a support mode that waits
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1105 with the fontification until the text is actually shown
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1106 (e.g. Just-in-time Lock mode, which is the default, or Lazy Lock
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1107 mode). Fontifying a file with several thousand lines in one go can
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1108 take the better part of a minute.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1109
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1110 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1111 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1112 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1113 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1114 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1115 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1116
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1117 **** Support for documentation comments.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1118 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1119 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1120 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1121 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1122
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1123 Currently two kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Suns Javadoc
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1124 and Autodoc which is used in Pike. This is by no means a complete
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1125 list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor of choice
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1126 is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1127
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1128 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1129 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1130 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1131 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1132 parens.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1133
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1134 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1135 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1136 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1137 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1138 not as configurable as it ought to be.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1139
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1140 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1141 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1142 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1143 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1144 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1145
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1146 *** Support for the AWK language.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1147 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1148 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1149 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1150 Here is a summary:
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1151
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1152 **** Indentation Engine
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1153 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1154
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1155 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1156 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1157 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1158 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1159 definition, or structured statement.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1160
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1161 The predefined indentation functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1162 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't be
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1163 any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1164
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1165 The command C-c C-q (c-indent-defun) hasn't yet been adapted for AWK,
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1166 though in practice it works properly nearly all the time. Should it
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1167 fail, explicitly set the region around the function (using C-u C-SPC:
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1168 C-M-h probably won't work either) then do C-M-\ (indent-region).
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1169
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1170 **** Font Locking
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1171 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1172 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1173 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1174 the AWK language itself.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1175
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1176 **** Comment Commands
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1177 M-; (indent-for-comment) works fine. None of the other CC Mode
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1178 comment formatting commands have yet been adapted for AWK mode.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1179
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1180 **** Movement Commands
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1181 Most of the movement commands work in AWK mode. The most important
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1182 exceptions are M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) and M-e
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1183 (c-end-of-statement) which haven't yet been adapted.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1184
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1185 The notion of "defun" has been augmented to include AWK pattern-action
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1186 pairs. C-M-a (c-awk-beginning-of-defun) and C-M-e (c-awk-end-of-defun)
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1187 recognise these pattern-action pairs, as well as user defined
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1188 functions.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1189
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1190 **** Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1191 Auto-newline insertion hasn't yet been adapted for AWK. Some of
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1192 the clean-ups can actually convert good AWK code into syntactically
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1193 invalid code. These features are best disabled in AWK buffers.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1194
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1195 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1196 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1197 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1198 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1199 composition-close, and incomposition.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1200
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1201 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1202 The functions c-hungry-backspace and c-hungry-delete-forward can be
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1203 bound to keys to get this feature without toggling a mode.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1204 Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1205
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1206 *** Better control over require-final-newline.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1207 The variable that controls how to handle a final newline when the
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1208 buffer is saved, require-final-newline, is now customizable on a
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1209 per-mode basis through c-require-final-newline. The default is to set
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1210 it to t only in languages that mandate a final newline in source files
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1211 (C, C++ and Objective-C).
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1212
51831
b1326ab47cbe A bit more talk about an API change in CC Mode.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51828
diff changeset
1213 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
b1326ab47cbe A bit more talk about an API change in CC Mode.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51828
diff changeset
1214 The elements in the syntactic context returned by c-guess-basic-syntax
b1326ab47cbe A bit more talk about an API change in CC Mode.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51828
diff changeset
1215 and stored in c-syntactic-context has been changed somewhat to allow
b1326ab47cbe A bit more talk about an API change in CC Mode.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51828
diff changeset
1216 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
b1326ab47cbe A bit more talk about an API change in CC Mode.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51828
diff changeset
1217 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
b1326ab47cbe A bit more talk about an API change in CC Mode.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51828
diff changeset
1218
b1326ab47cbe A bit more talk about an API change in CC Mode.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51828
diff changeset
1219 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
b1326ab47cbe A bit more talk about an API change in CC Mode.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51828
diff changeset
1220
b1326ab47cbe A bit more talk about an API change in CC Mode.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51828
diff changeset
1221 is now analysed as
b1326ab47cbe A bit more talk about an API change in CC Mode.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51828
diff changeset
1222
b1326ab47cbe A bit more talk about an API change in CC Mode.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51828
diff changeset
1223 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
b1326ab47cbe A bit more talk about an API change in CC Mode.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51828
diff changeset
1224
b1326ab47cbe A bit more talk about an API change in CC Mode.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51828
diff changeset
1225 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
b1326ab47cbe A bit more talk about an API change in CC Mode.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51828
diff changeset
1226 symbol.
b1326ab47cbe A bit more talk about an API change in CC Mode.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51828
diff changeset
1227
b1326ab47cbe A bit more talk about an API change in CC Mode.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51828
diff changeset
1228 This change might affect code that call c-guess-basic-syntax directly,
b1326ab47cbe A bit more talk about an API change in CC Mode.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51828
diff changeset
1229 and custom lineup functions if they use c-syntactic-context. However,
b1326ab47cbe A bit more talk about an API change in CC Mode.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51828
diff changeset
1230 the argument given to lineup functions is still a single cons cell
b1326ab47cbe A bit more talk about an API change in CC Mode.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51828
diff changeset
1231 with nil or an integer in the cdr.
51715
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1232
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1233 *** API changes for derived modes.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1234 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1235 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1236 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1237 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1238 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1239
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1240 **** New language variable system.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1241 See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1242
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1243 **** New initialization functions.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1244 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1245 give better control: c-basic-common-init, c-font-lock-init, and
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1246 c-init-language-vars.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1247
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1248 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1249 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1250 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1251 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1252
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1253 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1254 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1255 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1256 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1257 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1258
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1259 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1260 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1261 its substatement. E.g:
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1262
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1263 if (x)
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1264 x_is_true:
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1265 do_stuff();
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1266
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1267 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1268
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1269 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1270 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1271 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1272 variable c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros. A new syntactic symbol
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1273 cpp-define-intro has been added to control the initial indentation
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1274 inside #define's.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1275
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1276 **** New lineup function c-lineup-cpp-define.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1277 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1278 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1279 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1280 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1281 much line c-lineup-dont-change, which was used earlier, but handles
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1282 empty lines within the macro better.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1283
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1284 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1285 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1286 c-context-line-break and c-context-open-line.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1287
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1288 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1289 c-backslash-region tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1290 variable c-backslash-max-column which put a limit on how far out
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1291 backslashes can be moved.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1292
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1293 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1294 This is controlled by the new variable c-auto-align-backslashes. It
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1295 affects c-context-line-break, c-context-open-line and newlines
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1296 inserted in auto-newline mode.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1297
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1298 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1299 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1300 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1301 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1302 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1303 backslash) in the macro.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1304
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1305 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1306 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1307 the variable c-indent-comment-alist. The indentation behavior based
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1308 on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after #else
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1309 and #endif but indentation to comment-column in most other cases
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1310 (something which was hardcoded earlier).
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1311
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1312 *** New function c-context-open-line.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1313 It's the open-line equivalent of c-context-line-break.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1314
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1315 *** New lineup functions
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1316
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1317 **** c-lineup-string-cont
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1318 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1319 continues. E.g:
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1320
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1321 result = prefix + "A message "
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1322 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1323
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1324 **** c-lineup-cascaded-calls
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1325 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1326
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1327 **** c-lineup-knr-region-comment
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1328 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1329 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1330
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1331 **** c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1332 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks. Contributed by Kevin
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1333 Ryde.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1334
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1335 **** c-lineup-argcont
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1336 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1337 Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1338
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1339 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1340 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1341 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1342 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1343 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1344 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1345
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1346 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1347 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1348 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1349 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1350 context.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1351
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1352 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1353 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1354 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1355 happen when macros are involved.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1356
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1357 *** Improved the way c-indent-exp chooses the block to indent.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1358 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1359 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1360 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1361 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1362 line is left untouched.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1363
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1364 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1365 The function c-toggle-syntactic-indentation can be used to toggle
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1366 syntactic indentation.
6e2487a7e9ff CC Mode 5.30 news.
Martin Stjernholm <mast@lysator.liu.se>
parents: 51711
diff changeset
1367
40575
4ce7861c6181 Mention --no-window-system changes in the NEWS.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 40526
diff changeset
1368 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
4ce7861c6181 Mention --no-window-system changes in the NEWS.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 40526
diff changeset
1369 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
4ce7861c6181 Mention --no-window-system changes in the NEWS.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 40526
diff changeset
1370
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1371 +++
45574
a0ad5c5f6951 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45565
diff changeset
1372 ** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
a0ad5c5f6951 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45565
diff changeset
1373 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
a0ad5c5f6951 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45565
diff changeset
1374
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1375 +++
40526
b466f4f946a7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40493
diff changeset
1376 ** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1377 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1378 whose names begin with space are omitted.
40493
94818b20da05 Document the change in list-buffers-noselect wrt buffers visiting files
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 40487
diff changeset
1379
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
1380 +++
40526
b466f4f946a7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40493
diff changeset
1381 ** You can now customize fill-nobreak-predicate to control where
b466f4f946a7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40493
diff changeset
1382 filling can break lines. We provide two sample predicates,
b466f4f946a7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40493
diff changeset
1383 fill-single-word-nobreak-p and fill-french-nobreak-p.
b466f4f946a7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40493
diff changeset
1384
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1385 +++
40316
ddce8f484e75 New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 40296
diff changeset
1386 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
ddce8f484e75 New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 40296
diff changeset
1387 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry will always
ddce8f484e75 New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 40296
diff changeset
1388 start a new record regardless of when the last record is.
ddce8f484e75 New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 40296
diff changeset
1389
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
1390 +++
45977
ac1a42ec420b *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 45919
diff changeset
1391 ** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
ac1a42ec420b *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 45919
diff changeset
1392 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
40378
344e63612d00 renamed `html-xhtml' to `sgml-xml'
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 40316
diff changeset
1393 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
40215
77247104a65e mention html-xhtml
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 40190
diff changeset
1394 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
45977
ac1a42ec420b *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 45919
diff changeset
1395 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
40378
344e63612d00 renamed `html-xhtml' to `sgml-xml'
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 40316
diff changeset
1396 from the file name or buffer contents.
40215
77247104a65e mention html-xhtml
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 40190
diff changeset
1397
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
1398 +++
48728
ea9832f89c8f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 48645
diff changeset
1399 ** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
45614
8f47aa4a587a *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45610
diff changeset
1400
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1401 +++
41756
97f872fb595d Describe isearch-resume-enabled.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 41749
diff changeset
1402 ** New user option `isearch-resume-enabled'.
46989
eeab5bdaffa2 Fix typos.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46962
diff changeset
1403 This option can be disabled, to avoid the normal behavior of isearch
41756
97f872fb595d Describe isearch-resume-enabled.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 41749
diff changeset
1404 which puts calls to `isearch-resume' in the command history.
97f872fb595d Describe isearch-resume-enabled.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 41749
diff changeset
1405
45022
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
1406 ---
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1407 ** Lisp mode now uses font-lock-doc-face for the docstrings.
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1408
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1409 ---
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1410 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1411
45997
9ee4a7e22180 *** empty log message ***
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents: 45993
diff changeset
1412 +++
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1413 ** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
45997
9ee4a7e22180 *** empty log message ***
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents: 45993
diff changeset
1414 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
9ee4a7e22180 *** empty log message ***
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents: 45993
diff changeset
1415 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1416
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1417 ---
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1418 ** F90 mode has new navigation commands `f90-end-of-block',
45543
b436ae710691 *** empty log message ***
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents: 45499
diff changeset
1419 `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block', `f90-previous-block'.
45499
a35026845779 *** empty log message ***
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents: 45495
diff changeset
1420
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1421 ---
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1422 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
45610
e9b72e7f6062 Mention prolog-mode new var `prolog-font-lock-keywords'.
Thien-Thi Nguyen <ttn@gnuvola.org>
parents: 45574
diff changeset
1423 to support use of font-lock.
e9b72e7f6062 Mention prolog-mode new var `prolog-font-lock-keywords'.
Thien-Thi Nguyen <ttn@gnuvola.org>
parents: 45574
diff changeset
1424
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1425 +++
39849
10b9480202e8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 39784
diff changeset
1426 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
10b9480202e8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 39784
diff changeset
1427 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
10b9480202e8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 39784
diff changeset
1428 `same-window'.
10b9480202e8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 39784
diff changeset
1429
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1430 +++
39552
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
1431 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variables of the form `$foo' and
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
1432 `${foo}' in the specified new value of the environment variable. To
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
1433 include a `$' in the value, use `$$'.
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
1434
39881
9c1b9334eb73 Mark last change as documented in the manual.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39879
diff changeset
1435 +++
39879
fba70cf81a87 Document the significance of the trailing slash in elements of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39849
diff changeset
1436 ** File-name completion can now ignore directories.
fba70cf81a87 Document the significance of the trailing slash in elements of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39849
diff changeset
1437 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
fba70cf81a87 Document the significance of the trailing slash in elements of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39849
diff changeset
1438 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
fba70cf81a87 Document the significance of the trailing slash in elements of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39849
diff changeset
1439 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
fba70cf81a87 Document the significance of the trailing slash in elements of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39849
diff changeset
1440 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
fba70cf81a87 Document the significance of the trailing slash in elements of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39849
diff changeset
1441 candidate is a directory.
fba70cf81a87 Document the significance of the trailing slash in elements of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39849
diff changeset
1442
45022
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
1443 +++
46201
ec2505a6b272 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46128
diff changeset
1444 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
ec2505a6b272 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46128
diff changeset
1445 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1446 it remains unchanged.
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1447
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1448 +++
39552
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
1449 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
1450 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
1451 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
1452
52089
0713c3d48620 Mention `compilation-environment'.
John Paul Wallington <jpw@pobox.com>
parents: 51982
diff changeset
1453 ** New user option `compilation-environment'.
0713c3d48620 Mention `compilation-environment'.
John Paul Wallington <jpw@pobox.com>
parents: 51982
diff changeset
1454 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
0713c3d48620 Mention `compilation-environment'.
John Paul Wallington <jpw@pobox.com>
parents: 51982
diff changeset
1455 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
0713c3d48620 Mention `compilation-environment'.
John Paul Wallington <jpw@pobox.com>
parents: 51982
diff changeset
1456 subprocesses inherit.
0713c3d48620 Mention `compilation-environment'.
John Paul Wallington <jpw@pobox.com>
parents: 51982
diff changeset
1457
45022
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
1458 ---
39552
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
1459 ** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
1460
45022
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
1461 ---
40963
ff6a29bbaf7e Add note about system caret on MS Windows.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 40916
diff changeset
1462 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
ff6a29bbaf7e Add note about system caret on MS Windows.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 40916
diff changeset
1463 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
ff6a29bbaf7e Add note about system caret on MS Windows.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 40916
diff changeset
1464 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
ff6a29bbaf7e Add note about system caret on MS Windows.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 40916
diff changeset
1465
45022
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
1466 ---
41482
fe774ae6bd57 Added entry for tooltips on MS Windows.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 41471
diff changeset
1467 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
fe774ae6bd57 Added entry for tooltips on MS Windows.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 41471
diff changeset
1468 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
fe774ae6bd57 Added entry for tooltips on MS Windows.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 41471
diff changeset
1469
45022
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
1470 ---
49566
ca56eac8c658 Updated image support on MS Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 49549
diff changeset
1471 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
ca56eac8c658 Updated image support on MS Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 49549
diff changeset
1472 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
ca56eac8c658 Updated image support on MS Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 49549
diff changeset
1473 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
ca56eac8c658 Updated image support on MS Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 49549
diff changeset
1474 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
ca56eac8c658 Updated image support on MS Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 49549
diff changeset
1475 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
ca56eac8c658 Updated image support on MS Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 49549
diff changeset
1476 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
ca56eac8c658 Updated image support on MS Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 49549
diff changeset
1477 against.
44117
48ee57a8b28c Add news of image support on Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 44087
diff changeset
1478
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1479 ---
48501
41fb6d06759c Added note about sound support on MS Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 48060
diff changeset
1480 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
41fb6d06759c Added note about sound support on MS Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 48060
diff changeset
1481 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
49395
58c9926affeb Add note for mouse pointer support.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 49379
diff changeset
1482 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
48501
41fb6d06759c Added note about sound support on MS Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 48060
diff changeset
1483 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
41fb6d06759c Added note about sound support on MS Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 48060
diff changeset
1484 sound support for those formats.
41fb6d06759c Added note about sound support on MS Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 48060
diff changeset
1485
41fb6d06759c Added note about sound support on MS Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 48060
diff changeset
1486 ---
49395
58c9926affeb Add note for mouse pointer support.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 49379
diff changeset
1487 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
58c9926affeb Add note for mouse pointer support.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 49379
diff changeset
1488 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
58c9926affeb Add note for mouse pointer support.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 49379
diff changeset
1489
58c9926affeb Add note for mouse pointer support.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 49379
diff changeset
1490 ---
42725
7982df5e7d71 Add note about support for more mouse buttons in MS Windows.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 42703
diff changeset
1491 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
7982df5e7d71 Add note about support for more mouse buttons in MS Windows.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 42703
diff changeset
1492 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
7982df5e7d71 Add note about support for more mouse buttons in MS Windows.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 42703
diff changeset
1493 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
7982df5e7d71 Add note about support for more mouse buttons in MS Windows.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 42703
diff changeset
1494 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
7982df5e7d71 Add note about support for more mouse buttons in MS Windows.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 42703
diff changeset
1495
51506
eb007228d1de Document new System colors on MS-Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 51505
diff changeset
1496 ---
eb007228d1de Document new System colors on MS-Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 51505
diff changeset
1497 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
eb007228d1de Document new System colors on MS-Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 51505
diff changeset
1498 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in
eb007228d1de Document new System colors on MS-Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 51505
diff changeset
1499 much the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now
eb007228d1de Document new System colors on MS-Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 51505
diff changeset
1500 adds these colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu
eb007228d1de Document new System colors on MS-Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 51505
diff changeset
1501 for the default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground),
eb007228d1de Document new System colors on MS-Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 51505
diff changeset
1502 and uses some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
eb007228d1de Document new System colors on MS-Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 51505
diff changeset
1503 `list-colors-display' will show the list of System color names if you
eb007228d1de Document new System colors on MS-Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 51505
diff changeset
1504 wish to use them in other faces.
eb007228d1de Document new System colors on MS-Windows
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 51505
diff changeset
1505
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
1506 +++
43302
2f479ac769e1 (Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym)
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 43301
diff changeset
1507 ** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
2f479ac769e1 (Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym)
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 43301
diff changeset
1508 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
2f479ac769e1 (Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym)
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 43301
diff changeset
1509 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
2f479ac769e1 (Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym)
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 43301
diff changeset
1510 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
2f479ac769e1 (Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym)
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 43301
diff changeset
1511 Meta and Alt:
2f479ac769e1 (Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym)
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 43301
diff changeset
1512 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
2f479ac769e1 (Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym)
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 43301
diff changeset
1513 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
2f479ac769e1 (Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym)
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 43301
diff changeset
1514
48054
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
1515 * New modes and packages in 21.4
41246
003c53bb8906 Mention the French translations of the tutorial and the survival guide.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 41229
diff changeset
1516
51374
31bb2083978b *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 51300
diff changeset
1517 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
50794
4239cd7727ca Add an entry for GDB-UI.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 50773
diff changeset
1518
41246
003c53bb8906 Mention the French translations of the tutorial and the survival guide.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 41229
diff changeset
1519 ---
49648
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1520 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1521
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1522 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1523 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1524 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1525 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
46124
daab102d5c4f Added ido, kmacro, and bindat packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46064
diff changeset
1526
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
1527 ---
49648
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1528 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1529
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1530 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
44972
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1531 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1532 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1533 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1534 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1535 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1536
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1537 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1538 rectangle highlighting: Use S-return to start a rectangle, extend it
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1539 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1540 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1541
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1542 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1543 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1544 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1545 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1546 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1547 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1548 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1549
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1550 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1551 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1552 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1553
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1554 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1555 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1556
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1557 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1558 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1559 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1560 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1561
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1562 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1563 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1564 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you may customize the
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1565 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1566
49648
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1567 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1568 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1569 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1570 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1571
48054
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
1572 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
47415
9171c407208a Added more documentation for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47324
diff changeset
1573 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
9171c407208a Added more documentation for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47324
diff changeset
1574 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
9171c407208a Added more documentation for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47324
diff changeset
1575 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
9171c407208a Added more documentation for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47324
diff changeset
1576 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
9171c407208a Added more documentation for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47324
diff changeset
1577
9171c407208a Added more documentation for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47324
diff changeset
1578 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
9171c407208a Added more documentation for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47324
diff changeset
1579 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
9171c407208a Added more documentation for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47324
diff changeset
1580 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
9171c407208a Added more documentation for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47324
diff changeset
1581 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
9171c407208a Added more documentation for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47324
diff changeset
1582 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
9171c407208a Added more documentation for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47324
diff changeset
1583 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
9171c407208a Added more documentation for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47324
diff changeset
1584
9171c407208a Added more documentation for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47324
diff changeset
1585 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
9171c407208a Added more documentation for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47324
diff changeset
1586 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
9171c407208a Added more documentation for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47324
diff changeset
1587 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
9171c407208a Added more documentation for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47324
diff changeset
1588 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
9171c407208a Added more documentation for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47324
diff changeset
1589 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
9171c407208a Added more documentation for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47324
diff changeset
1590 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
9171c407208a Added more documentation for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47324
diff changeset
1591 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
47485
3e714e68ea77 Fix entry for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47433
diff changeset
1592 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
3e714e68ea77 Fix entry for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47433
diff changeset
1593 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
3e714e68ea77 Fix entry for keypad package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47433
diff changeset
1594 or local keymaps.
44972
0cdd0e248c05 Describe cua and keypad packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44957
diff changeset
1595
48054
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
1596 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
46124
daab102d5c4f Added ido, kmacro, and bindat packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46064
diff changeset
1597 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
daab102d5c4f Added ido, kmacro, and bindat packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46064
diff changeset
1598
47096
f0b41fba2995 Describe new kmacro bindings for f3/f4 and C-x e.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47085
diff changeset
1599 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
f0b41fba2995 Describe new kmacro bindings for f3/f4 and C-x e.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47085
diff changeset
1600 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
f0b41fba2995 Describe new kmacro bindings for f3/f4 and C-x e.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47085
diff changeset
1601 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
46124
daab102d5c4f Added ido, kmacro, and bindat packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46064
diff changeset
1602 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
daab102d5c4f Added ido, kmacro, and bindat packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46064
diff changeset
1603
46962
aeb54264d594 Describe new kmacro features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46959
diff changeset
1604 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
aeb54264d594 Describe new kmacro features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46959
diff changeset
1605 defined macros.
aeb54264d594 Describe new kmacro features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46959
diff changeset
1606
aeb54264d594 Describe new kmacro features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46959
diff changeset
1607 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
aeb54264d594 Describe new kmacro features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46959
diff changeset
1608 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
aeb54264d594 Describe new kmacro features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46959
diff changeset
1609 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
aeb54264d594 Describe new kmacro features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46959
diff changeset
1610 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
aeb54264d594 Describe new kmacro features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46959
diff changeset
1611 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
aeb54264d594 Describe new kmacro features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46959
diff changeset
1612 for more commands.
aeb54264d594 Describe new kmacro features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46959
diff changeset
1613
47085
a881d14145d0 etags now parses HTML.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 47070
diff changeset
1614 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
46962
aeb54264d594 Describe new kmacro features.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46959
diff changeset
1615 the keyboard macro ring.
46124
daab102d5c4f Added ido, kmacro, and bindat packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46064
diff changeset
1616
47313
52f90db3f174 Keyboard macro improvements.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47283
diff changeset
1617 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
52f90db3f174 Keyboard macro improvements.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47283
diff changeset
1618 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
47096
f0b41fba2995 Describe new kmacro bindings for f3/f4 and C-x e.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47085
diff changeset
1619
f0b41fba2995 Describe new kmacro bindings for f3/f4 and C-x e.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47085
diff changeset
1620 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
f0b41fba2995 Describe new kmacro bindings for f3/f4 and C-x e.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47085
diff changeset
1621 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
f0b41fba2995 Describe new kmacro bindings for f3/f4 and C-x e.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47085
diff changeset
1622 this behaviour via the variable kmacro-call-repeat-key and
f0b41fba2995 Describe new kmacro bindings for f3/f4 and C-x e.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47085
diff changeset
1623 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
f0b41fba2995 Describe new kmacro bindings for f3/f4 and C-x e.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47085
diff changeset
1624
47313
52f90db3f174 Keyboard macro improvements.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47283
diff changeset
1625 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
52f90db3f174 Keyboard macro improvements.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47283
diff changeset
1626 C-x C-k SPC will step through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
52f90db3f174 Keyboard macro improvements.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47283
diff changeset
1627 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
52f90db3f174 Keyboard macro improvements.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 47283
diff changeset
1628
49341
aa7e1948ad31 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 49316
diff changeset
1629 ---
aa7e1948ad31 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 49316
diff changeset
1630 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
aa7e1948ad31 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 49316
diff changeset
1631 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
aa7e1948ad31 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 49316
diff changeset
1632 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
aa7e1948ad31 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 49316
diff changeset
1633 C-c C-i b, and so on.
aa7e1948ad31 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 49316
diff changeset
1634
49648
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1635 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1636
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1637 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1638 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1639 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1640 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1641 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1642 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
4dd9a6db81d7 New entry for printing package.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49578
diff changeset
1643
40847
0de09e872237 An entry for Calc.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 40729
diff changeset
1644 +++
48054
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
1645 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
40847
0de09e872237 An entry for Calc.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 40729
diff changeset
1646
0de09e872237 An entry for Calc.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 40729
diff changeset
1647 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
0de09e872237 An entry for Calc.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 40729
diff changeset
1648 Emacs Lisp. Its documentation is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
40865
19d072877aaa Mention calccard.tex and calccard.ps.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 40847
diff changeset
1649 type "C-h i m calc RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
19d072877aaa Mention calccard.tex and calccard.ps.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 40847
diff changeset
1650 available in `etc/calccard.tex' and `etc/calccard.ps'.
40847
0de09e872237 An entry for Calc.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 40729
diff changeset
1651
40889
c410bf71eef7 Mention the addition of the ELisp reference.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 40865
diff changeset
1652 +++
48054
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
1653 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
45891
e945d29fa2b5 Mention Tramp.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 45874
diff changeset
1654
e945d29fa2b5 Mention Tramp.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 45874
diff changeset
1655 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
e945d29fa2b5 Mention Tramp.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 45874
diff changeset
1656 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
e945d29fa2b5 Mention Tramp.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 45874
diff changeset
1657 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
e945d29fa2b5 Mention Tramp.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 45874
diff changeset
1658 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
e945d29fa2b5 Mention Tramp.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 45874
diff changeset
1659 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
e945d29fa2b5 Mention Tramp.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 45874
diff changeset
1660 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
e945d29fa2b5 Mention Tramp.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 45874
diff changeset
1661 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
e945d29fa2b5 Mention Tramp.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 45874
diff changeset
1662 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
e945d29fa2b5 Mention Tramp.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 45874
diff changeset
1663 `rsync' to do the copying).
e945d29fa2b5 Mention Tramp.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 45874
diff changeset
1664
e945d29fa2b5 Mention Tramp.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 45874
diff changeset
1665 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
e945d29fa2b5 Mention Tramp.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 45874
diff changeset
1666 `su' and `sudo'.
e945d29fa2b5 Mention Tramp.
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 45874
diff changeset
1667
45022
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
1668 ---
48054
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
1669 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
47070
6976e7e4cb1e read-file-name-electric-shadow-mode -> file-name-shadow-mode
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 47062
diff changeset
1670 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
6976e7e4cb1e read-file-name-electric-shadow-mode -> file-name-shadow-mode
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 47062
diff changeset
1671 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
6976e7e4cb1e read-file-name-electric-shadow-mode -> file-name-shadow-mode
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 47062
diff changeset
1672 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
6976e7e4cb1e read-file-name-electric-shadow-mode -> file-name-shadow-mode
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 47062
diff changeset
1673 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method may
6976e7e4cb1e read-file-name-electric-shadow-mode -> file-name-shadow-mode
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 47062
diff changeset
1674 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
44622
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
1675
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
1676 ---
48054
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
1677 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
39738
9c1411458564 Add ruler-mode.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39647
diff changeset
1678 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
9c1411458564 Add ruler-mode.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39647
diff changeset
1679 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
9c1411458564 Add ruler-mode.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39647
diff changeset
1680 settings.
9c1411458564 Add ruler-mode.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39647
diff changeset
1681
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
1682 ---
48054
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
1683 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
51374
31bb2083978b *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 51300
diff changeset
1684 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
41623
8cf1bafe44b1 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41620
diff changeset
1685 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
8cf1bafe44b1 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41620
diff changeset
1686 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
8cf1bafe44b1 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41620
diff changeset
1687
45022
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
1688 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
1689
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
1690 ---
48054
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
1691 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
44822
0ecfbafcac13 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 44724
diff changeset
1692 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
0ecfbafcac13 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 44724
diff changeset
1693
48054
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
1694 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
46936
731e4a095774 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46878
diff changeset
1695 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
731e4a095774 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46878
diff changeset
1696 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
731e4a095774 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46878
diff changeset
1697 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
731e4a095774 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46878
diff changeset
1698 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
731e4a095774 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46878
diff changeset
1699 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
731e4a095774 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46878
diff changeset
1700
48060
26cda8b2f7ea +++/--- bugfix
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48054
diff changeset
1701 +++
48054
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
1702 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
1703 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
1704 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
1705 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
1706
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
1707 ---
45022
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
1708 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
44622
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
1709 Emacs will still work on terminals that require magic cookies in order
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
1710 to use standout mode, however they will not be able to display
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
1711 mode-lines in inverse-video.
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
1712
48728
ea9832f89c8f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 48645
diff changeset
1713 ---
52089
0713c3d48620 Mention `compilation-environment'.
John Paul Wallington <jpw@pobox.com>
parents: 51982
diff changeset
1714 ** cplus-md.el has been removed to avoid problems with Custom.
46687
d173e099056d *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46677
diff changeset
1715
49574
e4bf575fd91c *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49566
diff changeset
1716 ** New package benchmark.el contains simple support for convenient
e4bf575fd91c *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49566
diff changeset
1717 timing measurements of code (including the garbage collection component).
e4bf575fd91c *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49566
diff changeset
1718
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1719 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1720 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1721 in Indented-Text mode.
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1722
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1723 ** If you set `query-replace-skip-read-only' non-nil,
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1724 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1725 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1726
39552
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
1727
44724
867beadfbb38 *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44718
diff changeset
1728 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.4
40729
650fb912b343 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40686
diff changeset
1729
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1730 +++
51808
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1731 ** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1732 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1733 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1734 the mode line.
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1735
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1736 +++
51808
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1737 ** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1738 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1739
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1740 +++
51505
96facfc71511 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 51374
diff changeset
1741 ** The kill-buffer-hook is now permanent-local.
96facfc71511 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 51374
diff changeset
1742
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1743 +++
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1744 ** `select-window' takes an optional second argument `norecord', like
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1745 `switch-to-buffer'.
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1746
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1747 +++
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1748 ** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1749 selected window without impacting the order of buffer-list.
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1750
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1751 +++
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1752 ** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
51077
aafee8ba3f90 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50975
diff changeset
1753 text-properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1754 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1755
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1756 +++
50975
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
1757 ** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
1758 in the keymap.
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
1759
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1760 ---
50975
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
1761 ** VC changes for backends:
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
1762 *** (vc-switches BACKEND OPERATION) is a new function for use by backends.
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
1763 *** The new `find-version' backend function replaces the `destfile'
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
1764 parameter of the `checkout' backend function.
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
1765 Old code still works thanks to a default `find-version' behavior that
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
1766 uses the old `destfile' parameter.
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
1767
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1768 +++
51808
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1769 ** The new macro dynamic-completion-table supports using functions
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1770 as a dynamic completion table.
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1771
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1772 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1773
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1774 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1775 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1776 completions. This alist may be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1777 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1778 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1779 entered. dynamic-completion-table then computes the completion.
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1780
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1781 +++
51808
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1782 ** The new macro lazy-completion-table initializes a variable
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1783 as a lazy completion table.
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1784
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1785 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1786
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1787 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1788 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1789 ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1790 completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1791 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1792 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
fb3e76b44f41 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51744
diff changeset
1793
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1794 +++
50607
6ee7467b8fd7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50590
diff changeset
1795 ** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
6ee7467b8fd7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50590
diff changeset
1796
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1797 +++
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1798 ** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
50607
6ee7467b8fd7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50590
diff changeset
1799 for all (existing and future) frames.
6ee7467b8fd7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50590
diff changeset
1800
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1801 +++
50607
6ee7467b8fd7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50590
diff changeset
1802 ** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
50590
0a31ec45f727 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50553
diff changeset
1803
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1804 +++
50590
0a31ec45f727 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50553
diff changeset
1805 ** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
0a31ec45f727 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50553
diff changeset
1806
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
1807 +++
50590
0a31ec45f727 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50553
diff changeset
1808 ** The macro `with-syntax-table' does not copy the table any more.
0a31ec45f727 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50553
diff changeset
1809
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1810 +++
50543
ae1a0ad24e03 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 50509
diff changeset
1811 ** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
ae1a0ad24e03 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 50509
diff changeset
1812 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
50544
f7d63c53fb6c *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 50543
diff changeset
1813 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
50543
ae1a0ad24e03 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 50509
diff changeset
1814 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
ae1a0ad24e03 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 50509
diff changeset
1815 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
ae1a0ad24e03 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 50509
diff changeset
1816
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1817 +++
50474
b473e7c82366 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50312
diff changeset
1818 ** The function `number-sequence' returns a list of equally-separated
b473e7c82366 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50312
diff changeset
1819 numbers. For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9).
b473e7c82366 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50312
diff changeset
1820 By default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different separation
b473e7c82366 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50312
diff changeset
1821 as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns (1.5 3.5 5.5).
b473e7c82366 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50312
diff changeset
1822
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1823 +++
51608
05ddf95bcbff *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51602
diff changeset
1824 ** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
50509
81ee3475a52d *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50474
diff changeset
1825 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
81ee3475a52d *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50474
diff changeset
1826 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
81ee3475a52d *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50474
diff changeset
1827 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
81ee3475a52d *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50474
diff changeset
1828
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1829 ---
49883
4fb79f65681e *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49799
diff changeset
1830 ** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
4fb79f65681e *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49799
diff changeset
1831 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
4fb79f65681e *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49799
diff changeset
1832
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1833 +++
50050
32bb98768466 Mention `dcl-font-lock-keywords' and `dcl-font-lock-defaults'.
Thien-Thi Nguyen <ttn@gnuvola.org>
parents: 49887
diff changeset
1834 ** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character,
49766
d0dedef2274e *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49758
diff changeset
1835 unless it is followed by a `-' in a character constant (e.g. ?\s-A),
d0dedef2274e *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49758
diff changeset
1836 in which case it is still interpreted as the super modifier.
d0dedef2274e *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49758
diff changeset
1837 In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
d0dedef2274e *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49758
diff changeset
1838
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1839 +++
49668
f118fc83f5a5 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49658
diff changeset
1840 ** New function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the multibyteness
f118fc83f5a5 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49658
diff changeset
1841 of a string given to a process's filter.
f118fc83f5a5 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49658
diff changeset
1842
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1843 +++
49668
f118fc83f5a5 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49658
diff changeset
1844 ** New function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns t if
f118fc83f5a5 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49658
diff changeset
1845 a string given to a process's filter is multibyte.
f118fc83f5a5 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49658
diff changeset
1846
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1847 +++
49668
f118fc83f5a5 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49658
diff changeset
1848 ** A filter function of a process is called with a multibyte string if
f118fc83f5a5 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49658
diff changeset
1849 the filter's multibyteness is t. That multibyteness is decided by the
f118fc83f5a5 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49658
diff changeset
1850 value of `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is
f118fc83f5a5 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49658
diff changeset
1851 created and can be changed later by `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
f118fc83f5a5 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49658
diff changeset
1852
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1853 +++
49668
f118fc83f5a5 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49658
diff changeset
1854 ** If a process's coding system is raw-text or no-conversion and its
f118fc83f5a5 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49658
diff changeset
1855 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
f118fc83f5a5 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49658
diff changeset
1856 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
f118fc83f5a5 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49658
diff changeset
1857 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
f118fc83f5a5 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49658
diff changeset
1858 which was not compatible with the behaviour of file reading.
f118fc83f5a5 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49658
diff changeset
1859
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1860 +++
49657
f4b5295c3540 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49648
diff changeset
1861 ** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
f4b5295c3540 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49648
diff changeset
1862 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
f4b5295c3540 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49648
diff changeset
1863
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1864 +++
49530
4746ab25c458 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49520
diff changeset
1865 ** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
4746ab25c458 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49520
diff changeset
1866 on garbage collection.
4746ab25c458 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49520
diff changeset
1867
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1868 +++
49657
f4b5295c3540 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49648
diff changeset
1869 ** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
f4b5295c3540 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49648
diff changeset
1870 it is read from a file without decoding.
49378
f2d0a984961b *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 49347
diff changeset
1871
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1872 +++
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1873 ** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1874
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1875 +++
48953
b6cceff9402d *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 48899
diff changeset
1876 ** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
b6cceff9402d *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 48899
diff changeset
1877 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
b6cceff9402d *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 48899
diff changeset
1878 by calling `select-window'.
b6cceff9402d *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 48899
diff changeset
1879
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1880 ---
48953
b6cceff9402d *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 48899
diff changeset
1881 ** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
b6cceff9402d *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 48899
diff changeset
1882 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
b6cceff9402d *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 48899
diff changeset
1883 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
b6cceff9402d *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 48899
diff changeset
1884 need to have a name.
b6cceff9402d *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 48899
diff changeset
1885
48849
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1886 ** Byte compiler changes:
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1887
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1888 ---
48849
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1889 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1890 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1891 Emacs and XEmacs and may sometimes make the result significantly more
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1892 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1893 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1894 you anything.
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1895
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1896 +++
48849
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1897 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1898 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1899 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1900 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1901 forms:
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1902
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1903 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1904 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1905
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1906 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1907 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1908 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1909 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1910 macro expansion), but such tests may be nested. Note that `when' and
27e5569d6a32 Compiler changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48770
diff changeset
1911 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
49549
99be3a1e2589 Cygwin support patch.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 49530
diff changeset
1912
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1913 +++
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1914 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1915 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1916
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1917 +++
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1918 ** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1919 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1920 be inserted is translated through it.
48770
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
1921
48728
ea9832f89c8f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 48645
diff changeset
1922 +++
ea9832f89c8f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 48645
diff changeset
1923 ** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
48770
208d298f6d14 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 48736
diff changeset
1924 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
48728
ea9832f89c8f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 48645
diff changeset
1925 current file redefined it).
ea9832f89c8f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 48645
diff changeset
1926
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1927 +++
48027
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1928 ** New Lisp library testcover.el works with edebug to help you determine
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1929 whether you've tested all your Lisp code. Function testcover-start
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1930 instruments all functions in a given file. Then test your code. Function
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1931 testcover-mark-all adds overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1932 show where coverage is lacking. Command testcover-next-mark (bind it to
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1933 a key!) will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1934
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1935 *** Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely evaluated;
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1936 a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same value. The red
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1937 splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly complete their evaluation,
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1938 such as `error'. The brown splotches are skipped for forms that are expected
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1939 to always evaluate to the same value, such as (setq x 14).
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1940
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1941 *** For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to help
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1942 out the test coverage tool. The macro 1value suppresses a brown splotch for
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1943 its argument. The macro noreturn suppresses a red splotch.
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1944
48060
26cda8b2f7ea +++/--- bugfix
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48054
diff changeset
1945 +++
48027
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1946 ** New function unsafep returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1947 do anything dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1948 unsafe (calls dangerous function, alters global variable, etc).
ad86b7acaeec Added ses-mode, unsafep, testcover
Jonathan Yavner <jyavner@member.fsf.org>
parents: 48021
diff changeset
1949
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1950 +++
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1951 ** The new variable `print-continuous-numbering', when non-nil, says
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1952 that successive calls to print functions should use the same
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1953 numberings for circular structure references. This is only relevant
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1954 when `print-circle' is non-nil.
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1955
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1956 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1957 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1958
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1959 +++
47433
eb9a3f38650c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47415
diff changeset
1960 ** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
eb9a3f38650c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47415
diff changeset
1961 the scroll-bar-width frame parameter value is nil.
eb9a3f38650c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47415
diff changeset
1962
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1963 +++
47433
eb9a3f38650c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47415
diff changeset
1964 ** The new function copy-abbrev-table returns a new abbrev table that
eb9a3f38650c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47415
diff changeset
1965 is a copy of a given abbrev table.
eb9a3f38650c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47415
diff changeset
1966
47324
fd6bfaf82fa4 Minor change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47313
diff changeset
1967 +++
47062
632e05bbcb98 Describe --script.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47061
diff changeset
1968 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
632e05bbcb98 Describe --script.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47061
diff changeset
1969 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
47324
fd6bfaf82fa4 Minor change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47313
diff changeset
1970 can start with this line:
47062
632e05bbcb98 Describe --script.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47061
diff changeset
1971
632e05bbcb98 Describe --script.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47061
diff changeset
1972 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
632e05bbcb98 Describe --script.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47061
diff changeset
1973
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1974 +++
46959
2566b90da6fc *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 46936
diff changeset
1975 ** A function's docstring can now hold the function's usage info on
2566b90da6fc *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 46936
diff changeset
1976 its last line. It should match the regexp "\n\n(fn.*)\\'".
2566b90da6fc *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 46936
diff changeset
1977
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1978 ---
46677
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
1979 ** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
1980 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
86e8d59e2e49 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 46582
diff changeset
1981
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1982 +++
47621
2e93b2eb38c8 Mention minibufferp's optional buffer arg.
John Paul Wallington <jpw@pobox.com>
parents: 47616
diff changeset
1983 ** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional buffer
2e93b2eb38c8 Mention minibufferp's optional buffer arg.
John Paul Wallington <jpw@pobox.com>
parents: 47616
diff changeset
1984 argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted it defaults to
2e93b2eb38c8 Mention minibufferp's optional buffer arg.
John Paul Wallington <jpw@pobox.com>
parents: 47616
diff changeset
1985 the current buffer.
46878
901426f0ae5f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46787
diff changeset
1986
46582
c5989a0d356e *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46456
diff changeset
1987 ** There is a new Warnings facility; see the functions `warn'
c5989a0d356e *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46456
diff changeset
1988 and `display-warning'.
c5989a0d356e *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46456
diff changeset
1989
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1990 +++
46226
d6e8e4f90f8c *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 46214
diff changeset
1991 ** The functions all-completions and try-completion now accept lists
d6e8e4f90f8c *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 46214
diff changeset
1992 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
d6e8e4f90f8c *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 46214
diff changeset
1993 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
d6e8e4f90f8c *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 46214
diff changeset
1994 exported to Lisp.
d6e8e4f90f8c *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 46214
diff changeset
1995
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
1996 ---
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1997 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1998 much pure storage it will approximately need.
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
1999
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
2000 +++
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2001 ** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2002 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2003 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2004 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2005
51982
f3d2ca716f2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51934
diff changeset
2006 ---
46787
6f3953a83c05 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46775
diff changeset
2007 ** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
6f3953a83c05 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46775
diff changeset
2008 of one coding system from another coding system.
6f3953a83c05 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46775
diff changeset
2009
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2010 ** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2011 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2012 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2013 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2014 needed.
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2015
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2016 ** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2017 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2018 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2019 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2020 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2021 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2022
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2023 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2024 confirmation as before.
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2025
51215
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2026 ** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2027
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2028 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2029 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2030 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2031 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2032
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2033 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2034 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2035 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2036 between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2037 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2038 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
46214
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2039
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2040 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2041 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2042 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2043 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
e89fee6c4aea *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46201
diff changeset
2044
51215
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2045 ** Per-window fringes settings
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2046
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2047 Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and position
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2048 settings.
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2049
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2050 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2051 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2052 `set-window-fringes'.
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2053
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2054 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2055 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2056 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2057 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2058
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2059 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2060 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2061 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2062 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2063 an update of the display margins.
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2064
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2065 ** Per-window vertical scroll-bar settings
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2066
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2067 Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2068 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2069
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2070 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2071 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2072 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2073 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2074 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2075 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2076 of the display margins.
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2077
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2078 ** The function `set-window-buffer' now has an optional third argument
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2079 KEEP-MARGINS which will preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2080 and scroll-bar settings if non-nil.
7cb8c4e0b650 New per-window fringe and scroll-bar settings.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51182
diff changeset
2081
45979
87962bf716e3 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 45977
diff changeset
2082 +++
45977
ac1a42ec420b *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 45919
diff changeset
2083 ** Renamed file hooks to follow the convention:
ac1a42ec420b *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 45919
diff changeset
2084 find-file-hooks to find-file-hook,
ac1a42ec420b *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 45919
diff changeset
2085 find-file-not-found-hooks to find-file-not-found-functions,
ac1a42ec420b *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 45919
diff changeset
2086 write-file-hooks to write-file-functions,
ac1a42ec420b *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 45919
diff changeset
2087 write-contents-hooks to write-contents-functions.
ac1a42ec420b *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 45919
diff changeset
2088 Marked local-write-file-hooks as obsolete (use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook').
ac1a42ec420b *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 45919
diff changeset
2089
49549
99be3a1e2589 Cygwin support patch.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 49530
diff changeset
2090 ** The new variable `delete-frame-functions' replaces `delete-frame-hook'.
47739
ba21f6fad010 Mention `delete-frame-functions' replacing `delete-frame-hook',
John Paul Wallington <jpw@pobox.com>
parents: 47730
diff changeset
2091 It was renamed to follow the naming conventions for abnormal hooks. The old
ba21f6fad010 Mention `delete-frame-functions' replacing `delete-frame-hook',
John Paul Wallington <jpw@pobox.com>
parents: 47730
diff changeset
2092 name remains available as an alias, but has been marked obsolete.
ba21f6fad010 Mention `delete-frame-functions' replacing `delete-frame-hook',
John Paul Wallington <jpw@pobox.com>
parents: 47730
diff changeset
2093
45547
a227ea81fd67 *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45543
diff changeset
2094 ** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
a227ea81fd67 *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45543
diff changeset
2095 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
a227ea81fd67 *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45543
diff changeset
2096 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
a227ea81fd67 *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45543
diff changeset
2097 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
a227ea81fd67 *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45543
diff changeset
2098 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
a227ea81fd67 *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45543
diff changeset
2099
a227ea81fd67 *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45543
diff changeset
2100 ** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by lisp code
a227ea81fd67 *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45543
diff changeset
2101 to override the internal read-file-name function.
a227ea81fd67 *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45543
diff changeset
2102
45757
3f48cd2eb90a Added read-directory-name.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45744
diff changeset
2103 ** The new function `read-directory-name' can be used instead of
3f48cd2eb90a Added read-directory-name.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45744
diff changeset
2104 `read-file-name' to read a directory name; when used, completion
3f48cd2eb90a Added read-directory-name.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45744
diff changeset
2105 will only show directories.
3f48cd2eb90a Added read-directory-name.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45744
diff changeset
2106
46201
ec2505a6b272 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46128
diff changeset
2107 ** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
ec2505a6b272 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46128
diff changeset
2108 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
ec2505a6b272 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46128
diff changeset
2109 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
ec2505a6b272 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46128
diff changeset
2110
ec2505a6b272 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46128
diff changeset
2111 ** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
ec2505a6b272 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46128
diff changeset
2112 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
ec2505a6b272 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46128
diff changeset
2113 (require 'cl) when loaded.
ec2505a6b272 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46128
diff changeset
2114
88123
375f2633d815 New directory
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 52419
diff changeset
2115 ** The new Lisp library fringe.el controls the apperance of fringes.
375f2633d815 New directory
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 52419
diff changeset
2116
44134
ee7e76098967 Declarations in macros.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 44125
diff changeset
2117 ** The `defmacro' form may contain declarations specifying how to
ee7e76098967 Declarations in macros.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 44125
diff changeset
2118 indent the macro in Lisp mode and how to debug it with Edebug. The
ee7e76098967 Declarations in macros.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 44125
diff changeset
2119 syntax of defmacro has been extended to
ee7e76098967 Declarations in macros.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 44125
diff changeset
2120
ee7e76098967 Declarations in macros.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 44125
diff changeset
2121 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
ee7e76098967 Declarations in macros.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 44125
diff changeset
2122
ee7e76098967 Declarations in macros.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 44125
diff changeset
2123 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
ee7e76098967 Declarations in macros.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 44125
diff changeset
2124 declaration specifiers supported are:
ee7e76098967 Declarations in macros.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 44125
diff changeset
2125
ee7e76098967 Declarations in macros.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 44125
diff changeset
2126 (indent INDENT)
ee7e76098967 Declarations in macros.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 44125
diff changeset
2127 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
ee7e76098967 Declarations in macros.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 44125
diff changeset
2128
ee7e76098967 Declarations in macros.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 44125
diff changeset
2129 (edebug DEBUG)
ee7e76098967 Declarations in macros.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 44125
diff changeset
2130 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
ee7e76098967 Declarations in macros.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 44125
diff changeset
2131 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro.
ee7e76098967 Declarations in macros.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 44125
diff changeset
2132
43159
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2133 ** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2134
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2135 This is an alternative to using defadvice or substitute-key-definition
46989
eeab5bdaffa2 Fix typos.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46962
diff changeset
2136 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
43159
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2137 binding and lookup functionality.
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2138
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2139 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2140 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2141 original command.
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2142
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2143 Example:
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2144 Suppose that minor mode my-mode has defined the commands
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2145 my-kill-line and my-kill-word, and it wants C-k (and any other key
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2146 bound to kill-line) to run the command my-kill-line instead of
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2147 kill-line, and likewise it wants to run my-kill-word instead of
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2148 kill-word.
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2149
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2150 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2151 command remapping allows you to directly map kill-line into
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2152 my-kill-line and kill-word into my-kill-word through the minor mode
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2153 map using define-key:
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2154
43503
324295ebaf57 Modify description of command remapping which now uses a `remap'
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43493
diff changeset
2155 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
324295ebaf57 Modify description of command remapping which now uses a `remap'
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43493
diff changeset
2156 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
43159
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2157
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2158 Now, when my-mode is enabled, and the user enters C-k or M-d,
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2159 the commands my-kill-line and my-kill-word are run.
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2160
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2161 Notice that only one level of remapping is supported. In the above
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2162 example, this means that if my-kill-line is remapped to other-kill,
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2163 then C-k still runs my-kill-line.
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2164
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2165 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2166
43503
324295ebaf57 Modify description of command remapping which now uses a `remap'
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43493
diff changeset
2167 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
324295ebaf57 Modify description of command remapping which now uses a `remap'
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43493
diff changeset
2168 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
324295ebaf57 Modify description of command remapping which now uses a `remap'
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43493
diff changeset
2169 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
324295ebaf57 Modify description of command remapping which now uses a `remap'
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43493
diff changeset
2170 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
324295ebaf57 Modify description of command remapping which now uses a `remap'
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43493
diff changeset
2171
49758
0f9474583892 Renamed remap-command to command-remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49713
diff changeset
2172 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
0f9474583892 Renamed remap-command to command-remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49713
diff changeset
2173 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
43159
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2174
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2175 - key-binding now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
43503
324295ebaf57 Modify description of command remapping which now uses a `remap'
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43493
diff changeset
2176 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
43159
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2177
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2178 - where-is-internal now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2179 kill-line if my-mode is enabled), and the actual key binding for
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2180 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2181 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2182 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns C-k for kill-line and
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2183 <kill-line> for my-kill-line).
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2184
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2185 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2186 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2187 command was not remapped.
c69608fb5b19 Added command remapping.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43143
diff changeset
2188
45223
4cb22a508fe3 Added emulation-mode-map-alists.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45195
diff changeset
2189 ** New variable emulation-mode-map-alists.
4cb22a508fe3 Added emulation-mode-map-alists.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45195
diff changeset
2190
4cb22a508fe3 Added emulation-mode-map-alists.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45195
diff changeset
2191 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
4cb22a508fe3 Added emulation-mode-map-alists.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45195
diff changeset
2192 keymap alist separate from minor-mode-map-alist by adding their keymap
4cb22a508fe3 Added emulation-mode-map-alists.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45195
diff changeset
2193 alist to this list.
4cb22a508fe3 Added emulation-mode-map-alists.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45195
diff changeset
2194
43139
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2195 ** Atomic change groups.
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2196
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2197 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2198 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2199 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2200
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2201 (atomic-change-group
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2202 (insert foo)
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2203 (delete-region x y))
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2204
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2205 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2206 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2207 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2208 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2209
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2210 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2211 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2212
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2213 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2214 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2215 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2216 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2217
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2218 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2219 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2220 do this.
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2221
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2222 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2223 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2224 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2225 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2226
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2227 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2228 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2229 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2230 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2231 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2232 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2233 twice.
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2234
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2235 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2236 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2237 returned values, like this:
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2238
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2239 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2240 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2241
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2242 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2243 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2244 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2245
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2246 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2247 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2248 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2249 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2250 finished.
22ff542d67ee *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43100
diff changeset
2251
45692
bac6738f3c27 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45667
diff changeset
2252 +++
bac6738f3c27 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45667
diff changeset
2253 ** New variable char-property-alias-alist.
bac6738f3c27 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45667
diff changeset
2254
bac6738f3c27 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45667
diff changeset
2255 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
bac6738f3c27 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45667
diff changeset
2256 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
bac6738f3c27 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45667
diff changeset
2257 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
bac6738f3c27 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45667
diff changeset
2258 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
bac6738f3c27 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45667
diff changeset
2259
bac6738f3c27 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45667
diff changeset
2260 ** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
bac6738f3c27 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45667
diff changeset
2261
bac6738f3c27 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45667
diff changeset
2262 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
bac6738f3c27 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45667
diff changeset
2263 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
bac6738f3c27 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45667
diff changeset
2264 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
bac6738f3c27 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45667
diff changeset
2265 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
bac6738f3c27 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45667
diff changeset
2266
44680
39c7ce6f26c1 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44666
diff changeset
2267 ** New function remove-list-of-text-properties.
39c7ce6f26c1 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44666
diff changeset
2268
39c7ce6f26c1 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44666
diff changeset
2269 The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties' is almost the same
39c7ce6f26c1 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44666
diff changeset
2270 as `remove-text-properties'. The only difference is that it takes
39c7ce6f26c1 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44666
diff changeset
2271 a list of property names as argument rather than a property list.
39c7ce6f26c1 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44666
diff changeset
2272
49316
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2273 ** New function insert-for-yank.
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2274
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2275 This function normally works like `insert' but removes the text
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2276 properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list. However, if the
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2277 inserted text has a `yank-handler' text property on the first
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2278 character of the string, the insertion of the text may be modified in
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2279 a number of ways. See the description of `yank-handler' below.
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2280
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2281 ** New function insert-buffer-substring-as-yank.
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2282
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2283 This function works like `insert-buffer-substring', but removes the
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2284 text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list.
44724
867beadfbb38 *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44718
diff changeset
2285
867beadfbb38 *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44718
diff changeset
2286 ** New function insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
867beadfbb38 *** empty log message ***
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44718
diff changeset
2287
49316
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2288 This function is like insert-buffer-substring, but removes all
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2289 text properties from the inserted substring.
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2290
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2291 ** New `yank-handler' text property may be used to control how
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2292 previously killed text on the kill-ring is reinserted.
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2293
88123
375f2633d815 New directory
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 52419
diff changeset
2294 The value of the yank-handler property must be a list with one to five
49316
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2295 elements with the following format:
49493
67c5cfa83ddd Remove COMMAND element from yank handler.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49458
diff changeset
2296 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
49316
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2297
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2298 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2299 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2300 element on the kill-ring). If a yank-handler property is found,
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2301 the normal behaviour of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2302
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2303 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2304 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2305 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2306 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2307 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2308 rectangle.
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2309 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2310 yank-excluded-properties is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2311 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2312 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2313 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2314 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
49549
99be3a1e2589 Cygwin support patch.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 49530
diff changeset
2315 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
49316
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2316 FUNCTION may set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2317
88123
375f2633d815 New directory
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 52419
diff changeset
2318 *** The functions kill-new, kill-append, and kill-region now has an
375f2633d815 New directory
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 52419
diff changeset
2319 optional third argument to specify the yank-handler text property
375f2633d815 New directory
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 52419
diff changeset
2320 to put on the killed text.
49316
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2321
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2322 *** The function yank-pop will now use a non-nil value of the variable
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2323 `yank-undo-function' (instead of delete-region) to undo the previous
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2324 yank or yank-pop command (or a call to insert-for-yank). The function
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2325 insert-for-yank automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2326 element of the string argument's yank-handler text property if present.
1ace047a072a New yank-handler property.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49228
diff changeset
2327
45744
75e9d527da2b display-supports-face-attributes-p
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 45694
diff changeset
2328 ** New function display-supports-face-attributes-p may be used to test
75e9d527da2b display-supports-face-attributes-p
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 45694
diff changeset
2329 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
75e9d527da2b display-supports-face-attributes-p
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 45694
diff changeset
2330
75e9d527da2b display-supports-face-attributes-p
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 45694
diff changeset
2331 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
75e9d527da2b display-supports-face-attributes-p
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 45694
diff changeset
2332 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
75e9d527da2b display-supports-face-attributes-p
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 45694
diff changeset
2333 defined with defface.
75e9d527da2b display-supports-face-attributes-p
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 45694
diff changeset
2334
46246
097c4cba0759 Add entries for face-attribute-relative-p, merge-face-attribute.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 46226
diff changeset
2335 ** face-attribute, face-foreground, face-background, and face-stipple now
097c4cba0759 Add entries for face-attribute-relative-p, merge-face-attribute.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 46226
diff changeset
2336 accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how face
097c4cba0759 Add entries for face-attribute-relative-p, merge-face-attribute.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 46226
diff changeset
2337 inheritance is used when determining the value of a face attribute.
097c4cba0759 Add entries for face-attribute-relative-p, merge-face-attribute.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 46226
diff changeset
2338
097c4cba0759 Add entries for face-attribute-relative-p, merge-face-attribute.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 46226
diff changeset
2339 ** New functions face-attribute-relative-p and merge-face-attribute
097c4cba0759 Add entries for face-attribute-relative-p, merge-face-attribute.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 46226
diff changeset
2340 help with handling relative face attributes.
097c4cba0759 Add entries for face-attribute-relative-p, merge-face-attribute.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 46226
diff changeset
2341
49201
5a6e0cbe25e5 Put "process enhancements" before "network enhancements".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49200
diff changeset
2342 ** Enhancements to process support
5a6e0cbe25e5 Put "process enhancements" before "network enhancements".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49200
diff changeset
2343
5a6e0cbe25e5 Put "process enhancements" before "network enhancements".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49200
diff changeset
2344 *** Function list-processes now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
5a6e0cbe25e5 Put "process enhancements" before "network enhancements".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49200
diff changeset
2345 only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set are listed.
5a6e0cbe25e5 Put "process enhancements" before "network enhancements".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49200
diff changeset
2346
5a6e0cbe25e5 Put "process enhancements" before "network enhancements".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49200
diff changeset
2347 *** New set-process-query-on-exit-flag and process-query-on-exit-flag
5a6e0cbe25e5 Put "process enhancements" before "network enhancements".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49200
diff changeset
2348 functions. The existing process-kill-without-query function is still
5a6e0cbe25e5 Put "process enhancements" before "network enhancements".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49200
diff changeset
2349 supported, but new code should use the new functions.
5a6e0cbe25e5 Put "process enhancements" before "network enhancements".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49200
diff changeset
2350
5a6e0cbe25e5 Put "process enhancements" before "network enhancements".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49200
diff changeset
2351 *** Function signal-process now accepts a process object or process
5a6e0cbe25e5 Put "process enhancements" before "network enhancements".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49200
diff changeset
2352 name in addition to a process id to identify the signalled process.
5a6e0cbe25e5 Put "process enhancements" before "network enhancements".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49200
diff changeset
2353
49228
ac42843384b3 Replace "process private vars" with "process plist".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49201
diff changeset
2354 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
49549
99be3a1e2589 Cygwin support patch.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 49530
diff changeset
2355 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
49228
ac42843384b3 Replace "process private vars" with "process plist".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49201
diff changeset
2356
ac42843384b3 Replace "process private vars" with "process plist".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49201
diff changeset
2357 The new functions process-get and process-put are used to access, add,
ac42843384b3 Replace "process private vars" with "process plist".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49201
diff changeset
2358 and modify elements on this property list.
ac42843384b3 Replace "process private vars" with "process plist".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49201
diff changeset
2359
ac42843384b3 Replace "process private vars" with "process plist".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49201
diff changeset
2360 The new low-level functions process-plist and set-process-plist are
ac42843384b3 Replace "process private vars" with "process plist".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49201
diff changeset
2361 used to access and replace the entire property list of a process.
ac42843384b3 Replace "process private vars" with "process plist".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49201
diff changeset
2362
49201
5a6e0cbe25e5 Put "process enhancements" before "network enhancements".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49200
diff changeset
2363
43973
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2364 ** Enhanced networking support.
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2365
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2366 *** There is a new `make-network-process' function which supports
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2367 opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2368 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2369
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2370 - A server is started using :server t arg.
44072
434c70e973e8 Explain how to use featurep with make-network-process.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44058
diff changeset
2371 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
43973
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2372 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2373 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2374 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
49228
ac42843384b3 Replace "process private vars" with "process plist".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49201
diff changeset
2375 - The process' property list may be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
ac42843384b3 Replace "process private vars" with "process plist".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49201
diff changeset
2376 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
ac42843384b3 Replace "process private vars" with "process plist".
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49201
diff changeset
2377 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
43973
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2378
44072
434c70e973e8 Explain how to use featurep with make-network-process.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44058
diff changeset
2379 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
434c70e973e8 Explain how to use featurep with make-network-process.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44058
diff changeset
2380 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
434c70e973e8 Explain how to use featurep with make-network-process.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 44058
diff changeset
2381
43973
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2382 *** Original open-network-stream is now emulated using make-network-process.
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2383
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2384 *** New function open-network-stream-nowait.
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2385
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2386 This function initiates a non-blocking connect and returns immediately
49135
3752935a65db Add docs for new networking functions.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49120
diff changeset
2387 without waiting for the connection to be established. It takes the
3752935a65db Add docs for new networking functions.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49120
diff changeset
2388 filter and sentinel functions as arguments; when the non-blocking
3752935a65db Add docs for new networking functions.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49120
diff changeset
2389 connect completes, the sentinel is called with a status string
3752935a65db Add docs for new networking functions.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49120
diff changeset
2390 matching "open" or "failed".
43973
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2391
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2392 *** New function open-network-stream-server.
49135
3752935a65db Add docs for new networking functions.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49120
diff changeset
2393
3752935a65db Add docs for new networking functions.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49120
diff changeset
2394 This function creates a network server process for a TCP service.
3752935a65db Add docs for new networking functions.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49120
diff changeset
2395 When a client connects to the specified service, a new subprocess
3752935a65db Add docs for new networking functions.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49120
diff changeset
2396 is created to handle the new connection, and the sentinel function
3752935a65db Add docs for new networking functions.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49120
diff changeset
2397 is called for the new process.
43973
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2398
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2399 *** New functions process-datagram-address and set-process-datagram-address.
49135
3752935a65db Add docs for new networking functions.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49120
diff changeset
2400
3752935a65db Add docs for new networking functions.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49120
diff changeset
2401 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
3752935a65db Add docs for new networking functions.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49120
diff changeset
2402 and set the current address of the remote partner.
43973
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2403
48054
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
2404 *** New function format-network-address.
49135
3752935a65db Add docs for new networking functions.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49120
diff changeset
2405
3752935a65db Add docs for new networking functions.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49120
diff changeset
2406 This function reformats the lisp representation of a network address
3752935a65db Add docs for new networking functions.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49120
diff changeset
2407 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
3752935a65db Add docs for new networking functions.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49120
diff changeset
2408 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
3752935a65db Add docs for new networking functions.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49120
diff changeset
2409 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
3752935a65db Add docs for new networking functions.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 49120
diff changeset
2410 string for other formatting options.
48054
b302909e7e67 Document enhanced signal-process functionality.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 48027
diff changeset
2411
43973
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2412 *** By default, the function process-contact still returns (HOST SERVICE)
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2413 for a network process. Using the new optional KEY arg, the complete list
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2414 of network process properties or a specific property can be selected.
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2415
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2416 Using :local and :remote as the KEY, the address of the local or
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2417 remote end-point is returned. An Inet address is represented as a 5
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2418 element vector, where the first 4 elements contain the IP address and
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2419 the fifth is the port number.
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2420
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2421 *** Network processes can now be stopped and restarted with
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2422 `stop-process' and `continue-process'. For a server process, no
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2423 connections are accepted in the stopped state. For a client process,
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2424 no input is received in the stopped state.
7e66682c7ec6 Describe enhanced networking support.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43947
diff changeset
2425
45758
d6822e2dafb3 Add copy-tree.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45757
diff changeset
2426 ** New function copy-tree.
d6822e2dafb3 Add copy-tree.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45757
diff changeset
2427
42940
7c0e12d6edb5 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42874
diff changeset
2428 ** New function substring-no-properties.
7c0e12d6edb5 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42874
diff changeset
2429
43626
de43922d0921 Blinking cursor enhancement.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43607
diff changeset
2430 ** New function minibuffer-selected-window.
de43922d0921 Blinking cursor enhancement.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 43607
diff changeset
2431
44622
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
2432 ** New function `call-process-shell-command'.
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
2433
44957
15ba9db103f6 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44934
diff changeset
2434 ** The dummy function keys made by easymenu
15ba9db103f6 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44934
diff changeset
2435 are now always lower case. If you specify the
15ba9db103f6 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44934
diff changeset
2436 menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
15ba9db103f6 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44934
diff changeset
2437 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
15ba9db103f6 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44934
diff changeset
2438
15ba9db103f6 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44934
diff changeset
2439 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for
15ba9db103f6 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44934
diff changeset
2440 the bindings that were made with easymenu.
15ba9db103f6 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44934
diff changeset
2441
15ba9db103f6 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44934
diff changeset
2442 ** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional
15ba9db103f6 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44934
diff changeset
2443 argument. If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks
15ba9db103f6 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44934
diff changeset
2444 for a function that could be called with `call-interactively',
15ba9db103f6 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44934
diff changeset
2445 and does not return t for keyboard macros.
15ba9db103f6 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44934
diff changeset
2446
45022
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
2447 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
2448 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
2449
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
2450 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
2451 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
2452 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
2453 commands.
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
2454
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
2455 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
2456 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
2457 SQL buffer.
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
2458
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
2459 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
2460 (function (lambda ()
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
2461 (master-mode t)
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
2462 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
2463 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
2464 (function (lambda ()
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
2465 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
4359b383982c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44996
diff changeset
2466
44418
68cfd204d729 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44356
diff changeset
2467 ** File local variables.
68cfd204d729 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44356
diff changeset
2468
68cfd204d729 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44356
diff changeset
2469 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
68cfd204d729 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44356
diff changeset
2470 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
68cfd204d729 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44356
diff changeset
2471
42958
2d81f84af342 Document the extended color support for xterm and rxvt, and the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42940
diff changeset
2472 +++
42820
6477316b4dd9 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42786
diff changeset
2473 ** New function window-body-height.
6477316b4dd9 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42786
diff changeset
2474
6477316b4dd9 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42786
diff changeset
2475 This is like window-height but does not count the mode line
6477316b4dd9 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42786
diff changeset
2476 or the header line.
6477316b4dd9 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42786
diff changeset
2477
45757
3f48cd2eb90a Added read-directory-name.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45744
diff changeset
2478 ** New function format-mode-line.
3f48cd2eb90a Added read-directory-name.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45744
diff changeset
2479
3f48cd2eb90a Added read-directory-name.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45744
diff changeset
2480 This returns the mode-line or header-line of the selected (or a
46064
f0a33c7767fb format-mode-line now returns propertized string by default.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46034
diff changeset
2481 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
45757
3f48cd2eb90a Added read-directory-name.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 45744
diff changeset
2482
44160
9139b10bc7e6 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44134
diff changeset
2483 ** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
9139b10bc7e6 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44134
diff changeset
2484
9139b10bc7e6 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44134
diff changeset
2485 These functions are like `plist-get' and `plist-put' except that they
9139b10bc7e6 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44134
diff changeset
2486 compare the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
9139b10bc7e6 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44134
diff changeset
2487
44308
ecd559f0d5c3 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44295
diff changeset
2488 ** New function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu'
ecd559f0d5c3 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44295
diff changeset
2489
48728
ea9832f89c8f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 48645
diff changeset
2490 The `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' must not be used (as previously
44308
ecd559f0d5c3 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44295
diff changeset
2491 recommended) for making entries in the tool bar for local keymaps.
ecd559f0d5c3 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44295
diff changeset
2492 Instead, use the function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu', which lets
ecd559f0d5c3 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44295
diff changeset
2493 you specify the map to use as an argument.
ecd559f0d5c3 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44295
diff changeset
2494
42820
6477316b4dd9 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42786
diff changeset
2495 +++
43415
59c97b8695ee Document the optional second arg of `atan'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43390
diff changeset
2496 ** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
59c97b8695ee Document the optional second arg of `atan'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43390
diff changeset
2497
59c97b8695ee Document the optional second arg of `atan'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43390
diff changeset
2498 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
59c97b8695ee Document the optional second arg of `atan'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43390
diff changeset
2499 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
59c97b8695ee Document the optional second arg of `atan'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43390
diff changeset
2500 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
59c97b8695ee Document the optional second arg of `atan'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43390
diff changeset
2501
59c97b8695ee Document the optional second arg of `atan'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43390
diff changeset
2502 +++
42867
68f16b55e041 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42830
diff changeset
2503 ** You can now make a window as short as one line.
68f16b55e041 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42830
diff changeset
2504
68f16b55e041 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42830
diff changeset
2505 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
68f16b55e041 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42830
diff changeset
2506 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
68f16b55e041 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42830
diff changeset
2507 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
68f16b55e041 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42830
diff changeset
2508 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
68f16b55e041 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42830
diff changeset
2509 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
68f16b55e041 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42830
diff changeset
2510
68f16b55e041 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42830
diff changeset
2511 +++
42749
62c6ce7088f2 Document the new --color arg and tty-color-mode frame parameter.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42739
diff changeset
2512 ** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
62c6ce7088f2 Document the new --color arg and tty-color-mode frame parameter.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42739
diff changeset
2513 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
62c6ce7088f2 Document the new --color arg and tty-color-mode frame parameter.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42739
diff changeset
2514 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
62c6ce7088f2 Document the new --color arg and tty-color-mode frame parameter.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42739
diff changeset
2515 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
62c6ce7088f2 Document the new --color arg and tty-color-mode frame parameter.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 42739
diff changeset
2516
44418
68cfd204d729 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44356
diff changeset
2517 ** Mode line display ignores text properties in the value
68cfd204d729 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44356
diff changeset
2518 of a variable whose `risky-local-variables' property is nil.
68cfd204d729 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44356
diff changeset
2519
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
2520 ---
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
2521 ** Indentation of simple and extended loop forms has been added to the
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
2522 cl-indent package. The new user options
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
2523 `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation', `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
2524 `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can be used to customize the
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
2525 indentation of keywords and forms in loop forms.
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
2526
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
2527 ---
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
2528 ** Indentation of backquoted forms has been made customizable in the
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
2529 cl-indent package. See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
2530
42629
180b3f3a8fb8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42605
diff changeset
2531 ** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
180b3f3a8fb8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42605
diff changeset
2532
180b3f3a8fb8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42605
diff changeset
2533 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
180b3f3a8fb8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42605
diff changeset
2534 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
180b3f3a8fb8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42605
diff changeset
2535 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
180b3f3a8fb8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42605
diff changeset
2536 now:
180b3f3a8fb8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42605
diff changeset
2537
180b3f3a8fb8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42605
diff changeset
2538 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
180b3f3a8fb8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42605
diff changeset
2539
180b3f3a8fb8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42605
diff changeset
2540 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
180b3f3a8fb8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42605
diff changeset
2541 the time it takes to convert the format.
180b3f3a8fb8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42605
diff changeset
2542
180b3f3a8fb8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42605
diff changeset
2543 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
180b3f3a8fb8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42605
diff changeset
2544 wasteful.
180b3f3a8fb8 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42605
diff changeset
2545
42487
88fb2c8602aa *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42437
diff changeset
2546 ** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
88fb2c8602aa *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42437
diff changeset
2547 over minor mode keymaps.
88fb2c8602aa *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42437
diff changeset
2548
42425
aa6c345a4af0 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42367
diff changeset
2549 ** A hex escape in a string forces the string to be multibyte.
aa6c345a4af0 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42367
diff changeset
2550 An octal escape makes it unibyte.
aa6c345a4af0 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42367
diff changeset
2551
50607
6ee7467b8fd7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50590
diff changeset
2552 ** At the end of a command, point moves out from within invisible
6ee7467b8fd7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50590
diff changeset
2553 text, in the same way it moves out from within text covered by an
6ee7467b8fd7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50590
diff changeset
2554 image or composition property.
6ee7467b8fd7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50590
diff changeset
2555
50975
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
2556 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
2557 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
2558 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
2559 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
bf7c2783b20d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50897
diff changeset
2560 post-command-hook and thus does not care about intermediate states.
51608
05ddf95bcbff *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 51602
diff changeset
2561
44625
cd1ab4027e5a More updates.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44622
diff changeset
2562 ** Only one of the beginning or end of an invisible, intangible region is
cd1ab4027e5a More updates.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44622
diff changeset
2563 considered an acceptable value for point; which one is determined by
cd1ab4027e5a More updates.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44622
diff changeset
2564 examining how the invisible/intangible properties are inherited when new
50710
f2e284a34123 Update invisible/intangible handling spec.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50702
diff changeset
2565 text is inserted adjacent to them. (The `front-sticky' and `rear-sticky'
f2e284a34123 Update invisible/intangible handling spec.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50702
diff changeset
2566 properties control this.)
f2e284a34123 Update invisible/intangible handling spec.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50702
diff changeset
2567
f2e284a34123 Update invisible/intangible handling spec.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50702
diff changeset
2568 If the invisible/intangible would be inherited by any text inserted
f2e284a34123 Update invisible/intangible handling spec.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50702
diff changeset
2569 before this region, then the position before it is considered
f2e284a34123 Update invisible/intangible handling spec.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50702
diff changeset
2570 unacceptable, and point is forced to continue (if moving forwards, to
f2e284a34123 Update invisible/intangible handling spec.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50702
diff changeset
2571 the position following the invisible/intangible text; if moving
f2e284a34123 Update invisible/intangible handling spec.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50702
diff changeset
2572 backwards, to one position before). If the properties would be
f2e284a34123 Update invisible/intangible handling spec.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50702
diff changeset
2573 inherited by any text inserted after, then the position after is
f2e284a34123 Update invisible/intangible handling spec.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50702
diff changeset
2574 considered unacceptable, and point is forced to keep moving (if moving
f2e284a34123 Update invisible/intangible handling spec.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50702
diff changeset
2575 backwards, to the position preceding the invisible/intangible text; if
f2e284a34123 Update invisible/intangible handling spec.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50702
diff changeset
2576 moving forwards, to one position later).
44625
cd1ab4027e5a More updates.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44622
diff changeset
2577
cd1ab4027e5a More updates.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44622
diff changeset
2578 Thus, point can only go to one end of an invisible, intangible region, but
cd1ab4027e5a More updates.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44622
diff changeset
2579 not the other one. This prevents C-f and C-b from appearing to stand still
cd1ab4027e5a More updates.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44622
diff changeset
2580 on the screen.
cd1ab4027e5a More updates.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44622
diff changeset
2581
50710
f2e284a34123 Update invisible/intangible handling spec.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50702
diff changeset
2582 You should not set it up so that both the position before and the position
f2e284a34123 Update invisible/intangible handling spec.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50702
diff changeset
2583 after are unacceptable.
f2e284a34123 Update invisible/intangible handling spec.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 50702
diff changeset
2584
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2585 +++
44625
cd1ab4027e5a More updates.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44622
diff changeset
2586 ** field-beginning and field-end now accept an additional optional
cd1ab4027e5a More updates.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44622
diff changeset
2587 argument, LIMIT.
42367
e79ed5ab7b08 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42342
diff changeset
2588
42437
5426f6a09f35 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42434
diff changeset
2589 +++
42434
2c3aa5c554ca *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42425
diff changeset
2590 ** define-abbrev now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG. If
2c3aa5c554ca *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42425
diff changeset
2591 non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means that
2c3aa5c554ca *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42425
diff changeset
2592 it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the abbrevs.
2c3aa5c554ca *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42425
diff changeset
2593 Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always specify this
2c3aa5c554ca *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42425
diff changeset
2594 flag.
2c3aa5c554ca *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 42425
diff changeset
2595
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2596 ---
42281
18095fb6473e *** empty log message ***
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 42216
diff changeset
2597 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
18095fb6473e *** empty log message ***
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 42216
diff changeset
2598
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2599 ---
42281
18095fb6473e *** empty log message ***
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 42216
diff changeset
2600 ** The function insert-string is now obsolete.
18095fb6473e *** empty log message ***
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 42216
diff changeset
2601
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2602 ---
41596
3c035e37d086 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41594
diff changeset
2603 ** The precedence of file-name-handlers has been changed.
3c035e37d086 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41594
diff changeset
2604 Instead of blindly choosing the first handler that matches,
3c035e37d086 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41594
diff changeset
2605 find-file-name-handler now gives precedence to a file-name handler
3c035e37d086 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41594
diff changeset
2606 that matches near the end of the file name. More specifically, the
3c035e37d086 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41594
diff changeset
2607 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen.
3c035e37d086 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41594
diff changeset
2608 In case of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
3c035e37d086 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41594
diff changeset
2609
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2610 ---
41594
452efff38a6e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41501
diff changeset
2611 ** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
41847
7423116b7ac3 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41820
diff changeset
2612 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
7423116b7ac3 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41820
diff changeset
2613 bindings of the parent keymap.
41594
452efff38a6e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41501
diff changeset
2614
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2615 ---
41337
3a8e8dd8a64e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41298
diff changeset
2616 ** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
3a8e8dd8a64e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41298
diff changeset
2617 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
3a8e8dd8a64e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41298
diff changeset
2618 (see jit-lock-defer-contextually), then all of that text will
3a8e8dd8a64e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41298
diff changeset
2619 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
3a8e8dd8a64e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41298
diff changeset
2620 depends on text several lines further down (and when font-lock-multiline
3a8e8dd8a64e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41298
diff changeset
2621 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
3a8e8dd8a64e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41298
diff changeset
2622
3a8e8dd8a64e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41298
diff changeset
2623 s{
3a8e8dd8a64e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41298
diff changeset
2624 foo
3a8e8dd8a64e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41298
diff changeset
2625 }{
3a8e8dd8a64e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41298
diff changeset
2626 bar
3a8e8dd8a64e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41298
diff changeset
2627 }e
3a8e8dd8a64e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41298
diff changeset
2628
3a8e8dd8a64e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41298
diff changeset
2629 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
3a8e8dd8a64e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41298
diff changeset
2630 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a jit-lock-defer-multiline
3a8e8dd8a64e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41298
diff changeset
2631 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
3a8e8dd8a64e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41298
diff changeset
2632 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
3a8e8dd8a64e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41298
diff changeset
2633
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2634 ---
41298
dd0332958888 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41246
diff changeset
2635 ** describe-vector now takes a second argument `describer' which is
42183
ccf68d58861d Fix typos. From Juanma Barranquero <lektu@teleline.es>.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 42160
diff changeset
2636 called to print the entries' values. It defaults to `princ'.
41298
dd0332958888 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41246
diff changeset
2637
41229
70059cb88be4 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41099
diff changeset
2638 ** defcustom and other custom declarations now use a default group
70059cb88be4 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41099
diff changeset
2639 (the last group defined in the same file) when no :group was given.
70059cb88be4 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41099
diff changeset
2640
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2641 +++
41229
70059cb88be4 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41099
diff changeset
2642 ** emacsserver now runs pre-command-hook and post-command-hook when
70059cb88be4 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41099
diff changeset
2643 it receives a request from emacsclient.
70059cb88be4 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41099
diff changeset
2644
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2645 ---
41471
41ef4373121e *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 41439
diff changeset
2646 ** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
41ef4373121e *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 41439
diff changeset
2647 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
41ef4373121e *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 41439
diff changeset
2648 than 3 levels of nesting.
41ef4373121e *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 41439
diff changeset
2649
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2650 ---
40973
5959d9cfe456 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40963
diff changeset
2651 ** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
5959d9cfe456 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40963
diff changeset
2652 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
5959d9cfe456 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40963
diff changeset
2653 it in that buffer.
5959d9cfe456 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40963
diff changeset
2654
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2655 ---
41367
65eb0f7957c8 Fix a typo.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 41356
diff changeset
2656 ** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
41356
39332ec6c47d Fix typos.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 41355
diff changeset
2657 properties from surrounding text.
40973
5959d9cfe456 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40963
diff changeset
2658
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2659 +++
40729
650fb912b343 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40686
diff changeset
2660 ** New function `buffer-local-value'.
650fb912b343 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40686
diff changeset
2661
650fb912b343 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40686
diff changeset
2662 This function returns the buffer-local binding of VARIABLE (a symbol)
650fb912b343 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40686
diff changeset
2663 in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not have a buffer-local binding in
650fb912b343 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40686
diff changeset
2664 buffer BUFFER, it returns the default value of VARIABLE instead.
39552
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
2665
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2666 ---
40487
8c17e2ae6bf5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 40378
diff changeset
2667 ** New function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
8c17e2ae6bf5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 40378
diff changeset
2668 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
8c17e2ae6bf5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 40378
diff changeset
2669 clone to the other.
8c17e2ae6bf5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 40378
diff changeset
2670
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2671 +++
40487
8c17e2ae6bf5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 40378
diff changeset
2672 ** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
8c17e2ae6bf5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 40378
diff changeset
2673 *** the FACENAME returned in font-lock-keywords can be a list
43607
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 43602
diff changeset
2674 of the form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set
40487
8c17e2ae6bf5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 40378
diff changeset
2675 other properties than `face'.
8c17e2ae6bf5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 40378
diff changeset
2676 *** font-lock-extra-managed-props can be set to make sure those extra
8c17e2ae6bf5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 40378
diff changeset
2677 properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
8c17e2ae6bf5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 40378
diff changeset
2678
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2679 ---
43932
435ee4108bad Document removal of special treatment of fg:COLOR and bg:COLOR faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43931
diff changeset
2680 ** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
435ee4108bad Document removal of special treatment of fg:COLOR and bg:COLOR faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43931
diff changeset
2681 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2682 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2683 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2684 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2685
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2686 +++
40487
8c17e2ae6bf5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 40378
diff changeset
2687 ** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
8c17e2ae6bf5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 40378
diff changeset
2688 are used by define-derived-mode to make sure the mode hook for the
8c17e2ae6bf5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 40378
diff changeset
2689 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
8c17e2ae6bf5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 40378
diff changeset
2690
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2691 +++
50553
11c29e283064 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50544
diff changeset
2692 ** define-minor-mode now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
11c29e283064 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50544
diff changeset
2693 and simply passes them to defcustom, if applicable.
11c29e283064 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 50544
diff changeset
2694
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2695 +++
47433
eb9a3f38650c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47415
diff changeset
2696 ** define-derived-mode by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
eb9a3f38650c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47415
diff changeset
2697 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
eb9a3f38650c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 47415
diff changeset
2698
46226
d6e8e4f90f8c *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 46214
diff changeset
2699 +++
40487
8c17e2ae6bf5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 40378
diff changeset
2700 ** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
8c17e2ae6bf5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 40378
diff changeset
2701 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
51647
c9a97d52236b *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 51608
diff changeset
2702 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
40487
8c17e2ae6bf5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 40378
diff changeset
2703
40190
9ba78bf11cf1 Document changes in file-name-sans-extension and file-name-extension.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39975
diff changeset
2704 +++
9ba78bf11cf1 Document changes in file-name-sans-extension and file-name-extension.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39975
diff changeset
2705 ** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
9ba78bf11cf1 Document changes in file-name-sans-extension and file-name-extension.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39975
diff changeset
2706 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
9ba78bf11cf1 Document changes in file-name-sans-extension and file-name-extension.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39975
diff changeset
2707 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
9ba78bf11cf1 Document changes in file-name-sans-extension and file-name-extension.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39975
diff changeset
2708
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2709 +++
39778
939f548d08cd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39771
diff changeset
2710 ** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
939f548d08cd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39771
diff changeset
2711 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
939f548d08cd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39771
diff changeset
2712 accepts a float as UID parameter.
939f548d08cd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39771
diff changeset
2713
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2714 ---
39765
e8c0b3b54fc7 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 39738
diff changeset
2715 ** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
e8c0b3b54fc7 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 39738
diff changeset
2716
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2717 +++
39765
e8c0b3b54fc7 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 39738
diff changeset
2718 ** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in elisp files is now obeyed.
e8c0b3b54fc7 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 39738
diff changeset
2719
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2720 +++
45993
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
2721 ** The Emacs Lisp byte-compiler now displays the actual line and
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
2722 character position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
2723 of its warning and error messages have been brought more in line with
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
2724 the output of other GNU tools.
b974df2c611f *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
2725
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2726 +++
39849
10b9480202e8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 39784
diff changeset
2727 ** New functions `keymap-prompt' and `current-active-maps'.
10b9480202e8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 39784
diff changeset
2728
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2729 ---
39849
10b9480202e8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 39784
diff changeset
2730 ** New function `describe-buffer-bindings'.
10b9480202e8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 39784
diff changeset
2731
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2732 +++
39849
10b9480202e8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 39784
diff changeset
2733 ** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
10b9480202e8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 39784
diff changeset
2734 searching for an executable resp. an elisp file.
10b9480202e8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 39784
diff changeset
2735
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2736 +++
45614
8f47aa4a587a *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 45610
diff changeset
2737 ** Variable aliases have been implemented:
39552
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
2738
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2739 *** defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
46401
0616af8d6d42 Fix reference to `defvaralias' as a macro.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 46391
diff changeset
2740
0616af8d6d42 Fix reference to `defvaralias' as a macro.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 46391
diff changeset
2741 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
0616af8d6d42 Fix reference to `defvaralias' as a macro.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 46391
diff changeset
2742 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
0616af8d6d42 Fix reference to `defvaralias' as a macro.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 46391
diff changeset
2743 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
0616af8d6d42 Fix reference to `defvaralias' as a macro.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 46391
diff changeset
2744 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
39552
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
2745
46391
5d5a55d8897b Document third argument of defvaralias.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 46246
diff changeset
2746 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
5d5a55d8897b Document third argument of defvaralias.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 46246
diff changeset
2747 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
5d5a55d8897b Document third argument of defvaralias.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 46246
diff changeset
2748
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2749 *** indirect-variable VARIABLE
39552
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
2750
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
2751 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
2752 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
2753 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
2754
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
2755 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
2756 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
2757
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2758 +++
39552
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
2759 ** Functions from `post-gc-hook' are run at the end of garbage
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
2760 collection. The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
2761
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2762 +++
39604
3eb5c468047e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39601
diff changeset
2763 ** If the second argument to `copy-file' is the name of a directory,
39605
80c62639fd20 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39604
diff changeset
2764 the file is copied to that directory instead of signaling an error.
39604
3eb5c468047e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39601
diff changeset
2765
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2766 +++
39647
387ceba6fde4 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39605
diff changeset
2767 ** The variables most-positive-fixnum and most-negative-fixnum
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2768 hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2769
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2770 ---
41355
ffd42182dd37 Added note about locale-coding-system on Windows.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 41340
diff changeset
2771 ** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
ffd42182dd37 Added note about locale-coding-system on Windows.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 41340
diff changeset
2772 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
ffd42182dd37 Added note about locale-coding-system on Windows.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 41340
diff changeset
2773 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
ffd42182dd37 Added note about locale-coding-system on Windows.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents: 41340
diff changeset
2774
51926
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2775 ** Functions y-or-n-p, read-char, read-key-sequence and the like, that
402fb9100d33 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51902
diff changeset
2776 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
43754
877062848c63 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 43724
diff changeset
2777 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
877062848c63 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 43724
diff changeset
2778
39765
e8c0b3b54fc7 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 39738
diff changeset
2779 ** New packages:
e8c0b3b54fc7 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 39738
diff changeset
2780
51928
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2781 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2782 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2783 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2784 state of your program. It separates the input/output of your program from
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2785 that of GDB and displays expressions and their current values in their own
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2786 buffers. It also uses features of Emacs 21 such as the display margin for
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2787 breakpoints, and the toolbar.
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2788
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2789 Use M-x gdba to start GDB-UI.
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2790
39765
e8c0b3b54fc7 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 39738
diff changeset
2791 *** The new package syntax.el provides an efficient way to find the
e8c0b3b54fc7 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 39738
diff changeset
2792 current syntactic context (as returned by parse-partial-sexp).
e8c0b3b54fc7 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 39738
diff changeset
2793
46124
daab102d5c4f Added ido, kmacro, and bindat packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46064
diff changeset
2794 *** The new package bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
daab102d5c4f Added ido, kmacro, and bindat packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46064
diff changeset
2795 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
daab102d5c4f Added ido, kmacro, and bindat packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46064
diff changeset
2796 data structures.
daab102d5c4f Added ido, kmacro, and bindat packages.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 46064
diff changeset
2797
41340
00ed4838100e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 41337
diff changeset
2798 *** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
42703
8b35cce1f9c8 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 42681
diff changeset
2799 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
8b35cce1f9c8 *** empty log message ***
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents: 42681
diff changeset
2800
44622
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
2801 *** The new package button.el implements simple and fast `clickable buttons'
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
2802 in emacs buffers. `buttons' are much lighter-weight than the `widgets'
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
2803 implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that doesn't
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
2804 require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for such things
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
2805 as help and apropos buffers.
a632dc3d85af Add entries for some things I did earlier:
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 44589
diff changeset
2806
39552
fa9fb33863fe *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39517
diff changeset
2807
51928
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2808 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2809
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2810 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2811 been added.
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2812
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2813
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2814 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2815
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2816 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2817 with Custom.
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2818
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2819 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2820 as mule-utf-8. Coding system `utf-16-le-dos' is useful as the value
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2821 of `selection-coding-system' in MS Windows, allowing you to paste
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2822 multilingual text from the clipboard. Set it interactively with
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2823 C-x RET x or in .emacs with `(set-selection-coding-system 'utf-16-le-dos)'.
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2824
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2825 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2826 in UTF-8 locales).
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2827
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2828 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2829 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2830 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2831 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2832 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2833 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2834 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2835 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2836 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2837 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2838
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2839 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2840 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2841
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2842 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2843 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2844 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2845 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behaviour is actually
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2846 contrary to the compound text specification.
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2847
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2848
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2849 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2850
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2851 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2852
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2853 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2854
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2855
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2856 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2857
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2858 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2859
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2860 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2861 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2862 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2863 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2864 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2865
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2866 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2867 were changed.
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2868
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2869 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2870 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2871
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2872 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2873 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2874 instead of using default-major-mode.
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2875
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2876 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2877 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2878 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2879 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2880 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2881 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2882 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2883
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2884 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2885 NEWS.
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2886
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2887
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2888 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2889
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2890 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2891 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2892 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2893
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2894 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2895 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2896
c94d493b710a Merge in the changes for versions 21.2 and 21.3 as
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 51926
diff changeset
2897
25995
0c93f1c6603a Note --with-pop change.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 25992
diff changeset
2898 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
0c93f1c6603a Note --with-pop change.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 25992
diff changeset
2899
36039
9c2bd5a836b3 point to INSTALL
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35937
diff changeset
2900 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
9c2bd5a836b3 point to INSTALL
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35937
diff changeset
2901 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
9c2bd5a836b3 point to INSTALL
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35937
diff changeset
2902 charsets in this release.
9c2bd5a836b3 point to INSTALL
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35937
diff changeset
2903
30576
e53905a0a16b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30568
diff changeset
2904 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
e53905a0a16b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30568
diff changeset
2905
31007
0e3404fe9965 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31004
diff changeset
2906 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
0e3404fe9965 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31004
diff changeset
2907
28166
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
2908 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
29962
cb2595f03c92 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 29949
diff changeset
2909 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
cb2595f03c92 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 29949
diff changeset
2910 to list them.
29696
a5051216d618 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29676
diff changeset
2911
30467
26afdae5ea13 --disable-largefile, 64-bit solaris
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 30445
diff changeset
2912 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
32182
f5d09b70a4b8 irix64, gnus-mule.el
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 32050
diff changeset
2913 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
33484
e64bda3bd077 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33411
diff changeset
2914 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
e64bda3bd077 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33411
diff changeset
2915 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
e64bda3bd077 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33411
diff changeset
2916 necessary changes to unexec.
30576
e53905a0a16b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30568
diff changeset
2917
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2918 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2919 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2920
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2921 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2922 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2923
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2924 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2925 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
32428
e67d8ebd2b24 windows/mac non-support
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 32314
diff changeset
2926
32865
34e286ed22a5 Say that Emacs can now be built on the Macintosh.
Andrew Choi <akochoi@shaw.ca>
parents: 32845
diff changeset
2927 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
32966
c75de0056053 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 32915
diff changeset
2928 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
34204
10c8428f0fd1 Point to the Mac OS chapter in the docs.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34191
diff changeset
2929 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
10c8428f0fd1 Point to the Mac OS chapter in the docs.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34191
diff changeset
2930 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
10c8428f0fd1 Point to the Mac OS chapter in the docs.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34191
diff changeset
2931 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
32428
e67d8ebd2b24 windows/mac non-support
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 32314
diff changeset
2932
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2933 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2934 new display features described below.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2935
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
2936
28166
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
2937 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
2938
36821
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2939 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2940
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2941 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2942 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2943 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2944 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2945 the text.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2946
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2947 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2948
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2949 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2950 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2951 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2952 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2953 specify a font.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2954
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2955 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2956 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2957 under Lisp changes, below.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2958
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2959 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2960
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2961 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2962 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2963 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2964 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2965 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2966 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2967 on terminals.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2968
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2969 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2970 supported on character terminals.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2971
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2972 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2973 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2974 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2975 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2976
36821
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2977 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2978
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2979 ** Sound support
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2980
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2981 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2982 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2983 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
39075
8722aa0ae475 Mark (almost) all entries either --- or +++.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39031
diff changeset
2984 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
8722aa0ae475 Mark (almost) all entries either --- or +++.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39031
diff changeset
2985 sound support.
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
2986
36821
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2987 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2988
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2989 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2990 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2991 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2992 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2993
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2994 - User option: max-mini-window-height
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2995
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2996 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2997 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2998 specifies a number of lines.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
2999
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3000 Default is 0.25.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3001
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3002 - User option: resize-mini-windows
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3003
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3004 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3005 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3006 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3007 again.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3008
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3009 Default is `grow-only'.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3010
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3011 ** LessTif support.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3012
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3013 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
37155
28fe777ce995 Change version of LessTif that's required.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37077
diff changeset
3014 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
36821
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3015
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3016 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3017
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3018 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3019 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3020 non-nil.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3021
39485
5e20b8bbcc45 Document the support for file selection dialog on MS-Windows.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39441
diff changeset
3022 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
5e20b8bbcc45 Document the support for file selection dialog on MS-Windows.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39441
diff changeset
3023
5e20b8bbcc45 Document the support for file selection dialog on MS-Windows.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39441
diff changeset
3024 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
5e20b8bbcc45 Document the support for file selection dialog on MS-Windows.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39441
diff changeset
3025 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
5e20b8bbcc45 Document the support for file selection dialog on MS-Windows.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39441
diff changeset
3026 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
5e20b8bbcc45 Document the support for file selection dialog on MS-Windows.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39441
diff changeset
3027
36821
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3028 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3029
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3030 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3031 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3032 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3033 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3034 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3035 Emacs.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3036
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3037 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3038 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3039 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3040 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3041 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3042 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3043
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3044 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3045 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3046 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3047 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3048 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3049 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3050
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3051 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3052 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3053 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
37156
f59630066b4b Fix a typo.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37155
diff changeset
3054 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
36821
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3055 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3056
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3057 ** Tool bar support.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3058
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3059 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3060 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3061 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3062 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3063 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3064 icons will be used.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3065
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3066 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
41439
7a15f05f14e2 Remove sentence about contributions to PBM icons.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 41437
diff changeset
3067 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
36821
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3068
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3069 ** Tooltips.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3070
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3071 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3072 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3073 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3074
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3075 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3076 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3077 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3078 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3079
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3080 ** Automatic Hscrolling
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3081
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3082 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3083 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3084 customized.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3085
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3086 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3087 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3088 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3089 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3090 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3091
36821
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3092 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3093 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3094 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
37228
21998919cfe9 show-cursor-in-non-selected-windows is no cursor-in-non-selected-windows.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37222
diff changeset
3095 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
36821
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3096 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
36885
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
3097 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
36821
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3098
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3099 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3100 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3101 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3102 customizing face `fringe'.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3103
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3104 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3105 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3106 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3107 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3108 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3109 the window to be partially obscured.)
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3110
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3111 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
38832
ce6b6f1fd86f Correct description of `mode-line-inverse-video'.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 38649
diff changeset
3112 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
ce6b6f1fd86f Correct description of `mode-line-inverse-video'.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 38649
diff changeset
3113 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
ce6b6f1fd86f Correct description of `mode-line-inverse-video'.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 38649
diff changeset
3114 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
36821
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3115
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3116 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3117
36848
87bf5cef20c7 Mode line is mouse-sensitive on all systems which have a mouse.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36821
diff changeset
3118 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
87bf5cef20c7 Mode line is mouse-sensitive on all systems which have a mouse.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36821
diff changeset
3119 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
87bf5cef20c7 Mode line is mouse-sensitive on all systems which have a mouse.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36821
diff changeset
3120 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
87bf5cef20c7 Mode line is mouse-sensitive on all systems which have a mouse.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36821
diff changeset
3121 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
87bf5cef20c7 Mode line is mouse-sensitive on all systems which have a mouse.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36821
diff changeset
3122 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
87bf5cef20c7 Mode line is mouse-sensitive on all systems which have a mouse.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36821
diff changeset
3123 have enabled one.
36821
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3124
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3125 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3126
40916
4a749a84888c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40889
diff changeset
3127 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
4a749a84888c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40889
diff changeset
3128
4a749a84888c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40889
diff changeset
3129 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
36821
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3130
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3131 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3132 `*') toggles the status.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3133
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3134 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3135
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3136 ** Hourglass pointer
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3137
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3138 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3139 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3140
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3141 ** Blinking cursor
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3142
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3143 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3144 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3145 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3146 the group `cursor'.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3147
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3148 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3149
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3150 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3151 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3152 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3153 details.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3154
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3155 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3156 have to do anything to activate it.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3157
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3158 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3159
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3160 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3161 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3162
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3163 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3164 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3165 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3166 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3167 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3168 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3169 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3170 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3171
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3172 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3173 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3174 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3175 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3176 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3177 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3178
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3179 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3180 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3181
36821
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3182 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3183 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3184 buffer by default.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3185
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3186 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3187 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3188 beginning and end of the buffer.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3189
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3190 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3191 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3192 signaled.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3193
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3194 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3195 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3196
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3197 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3198 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3199 this behavior.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3200
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3201 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
36821
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3202 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3203 Emacs dump core.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3204
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3205 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3206
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3207 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3208 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3209 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3210
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3211 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3212 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3213 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3214
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3215 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3216 using that menu.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3217
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3218 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3219
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3220 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3221 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3222 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3223 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3224 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3225 whitespace.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3226
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3227 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3228 all frames except the selected one.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3229
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3230 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3231 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3232
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3233 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3234 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3235 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3236 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3237 `Info-use-header-line'.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3238
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3239 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3240 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3241 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3242
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3243 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3244
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3245 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3246 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3247 `fr-drdref.tex'.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3248
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3249 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3250 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3251 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3252 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3253
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3254 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
38067
c1e43c8d51d2 Clarify the meaning of ``load-path is not customizable''. Someone just
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38012
diff changeset
3255
38107
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 38102
diff changeset
3256 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
38067
c1e43c8d51d2 Clarify the meaning of ``load-path is not customizable''. Someone just
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38012
diff changeset
3257 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
c1e43c8d51d2 Clarify the meaning of ``load-path is not customizable''. Someone just
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38012
diff changeset
3258 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
c1e43c8d51d2 Clarify the meaning of ``load-path is not customizable''. Someone just
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38012
diff changeset
3259 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
36821
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3260
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3261 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3262 point in a pop-up window.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3263
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3264 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3265 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3266 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3267
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3268 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3269 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3270
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3271 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3272 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3273 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
37365
cf22cb863f75 Fix a typo in auto-save-list-file-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37289
diff changeset
3274 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
36821
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3275
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3276 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
3caf523e6afd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36811
diff changeset
3277
34271
52c06c998aac *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 34204
diff changeset
3278 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
52c06c998aac *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 34204
diff changeset
3279 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
52c06c998aac *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 34204
diff changeset
3280
33796
10ffa5b56f53 mention `delete-trailing-whitespace'
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 33720
diff changeset
3281 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
33990
d9a19778f425 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33913
diff changeset
3282 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
33796
10ffa5b56f53 mention `delete-trailing-whitespace'
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 33720
diff changeset
3283 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
10ffa5b56f53 mention `delete-trailing-whitespace'
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 33720
diff changeset
3284
33559
c6a08bfab7fd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33541
diff changeset
3285 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
35937
f6e7e24f14e9 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35927
diff changeset
3286 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
f6e7e24f14e9 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35927
diff changeset
3287 non-nil.
33559
c6a08bfab7fd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33541
diff changeset
3288
31728
1b791fcfaa10 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31641
diff changeset
3289 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
1b791fcfaa10 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31641
diff changeset
3290 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
1b791fcfaa10 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31641
diff changeset
3291 file that is already visited under a different name.
1b791fcfaa10 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31641
diff changeset
3292
31807
db5ea3d2a1b4 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31742
diff changeset
3293 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
db5ea3d2a1b4 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31742
diff changeset
3294 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
db5ea3d2a1b4 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31742
diff changeset
3295
31728
1b791fcfaa10 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31641
diff changeset
3296 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
32280
e3b6714d835d Fix a typo.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 32266
diff changeset
3297 and displays information about that.
31248
87ff760a4902 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 31231
diff changeset
3298
30693
fc3acf3f8131 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30650
diff changeset
3299 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
fc3acf3f8131 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30650
diff changeset
3300 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
fc3acf3f8131 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30650
diff changeset
3301
fc3acf3f8131 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30650
diff changeset
3302 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
fc3acf3f8131 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30650
diff changeset
3303 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
fc3acf3f8131 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30650
diff changeset
3304 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
fc3acf3f8131 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30650
diff changeset
3305 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
fc3acf3f8131 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30650
diff changeset
3306 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
fc3acf3f8131 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30650
diff changeset
3307 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
fc3acf3f8131 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30650
diff changeset
3308
29532
9609bc6529ac executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29509
diff changeset
3309 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
31007
0e3404fe9965 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31004
diff changeset
3310 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
29532
9609bc6529ac executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29509
diff changeset
3311
29509
fc84e59f692c Preferred coding system change.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29506
diff changeset
3312 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
fc84e59f692c Preferred coding system change.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29506
diff changeset
3313 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
fc84e59f692c Preferred coding system change.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29506
diff changeset
3314 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
fc84e59f692c Preferred coding system change.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29506
diff changeset
3315 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
fc84e59f692c Preferred coding system change.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29506
diff changeset
3316 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
fc84e59f692c Preferred coding system change.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29506
diff changeset
3317 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
fc84e59f692c Preferred coding system change.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29506
diff changeset
3318 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
fc84e59f692c Preferred coding system change.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29506
diff changeset
3319
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3320 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3321 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3322
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3323 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3324 system for keyboard input.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3325
30296
8454f2730931 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30290
diff changeset
3326 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
8454f2730931 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30290
diff changeset
3327 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
8454f2730931 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30290
diff changeset
3328 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
8454f2730931 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30290
diff changeset
3329 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
8454f2730931 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30290
diff changeset
3330 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
30357
2696b797cd2f *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 30339
diff changeset
3331 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
30296
8454f2730931 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30290
diff changeset
3332 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
30357
2696b797cd2f *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 30339
diff changeset
3333 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
2696b797cd2f *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 30339
diff changeset
3334 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
30205
e596e66d3044 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 30203
diff changeset
3335
29506
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
3336 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
3337 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
3338
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
3339 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
3340 displays all characters in that character set.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
3341
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
3342 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
3343 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
3344
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3345 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3346 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3347 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3348
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3349 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3350 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3351 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3352 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3353 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3354 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3355 and Polish `slash'.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3356
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3357 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3358 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3359 of the tutorial.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3360
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3361 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3362 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3363 Lisp Coding Convention".
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3364
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3365 new command old-binding
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3366 --- ------- -----------
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3367 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3368 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3369 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3370
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3371 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3372 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3373 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3374
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3375 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3376 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3377 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3378 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3379 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3380 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3381
39885
91b2bb6856b0 List the new input methods introduced with Emacs 21.1.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39881
diff changeset
3382 ** There are new Leim input methods.
91b2bb6856b0 List the new input methods introduced with Emacs 21.1.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39881
diff changeset
3383 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
91b2bb6856b0 List the new input methods introduced with Emacs 21.1.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39881
diff changeset
3384 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
91b2bb6856b0 List the new input methods introduced with Emacs 21.1.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39881
diff changeset
3385 package.
91b2bb6856b0 List the new input methods introduced with Emacs 21.1.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39881
diff changeset
3386
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3387 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3388 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3389 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3390 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3391 "`", you must type "=q".
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3392
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3393 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3394 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3395 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3396 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3397 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3398 on.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3399
29218
e956cc90f6c0 newcomment and the change of binding for M-;
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 29162
diff changeset
3400 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
31026
3cd6db455d11 Mark comment-dwim as described in the manual.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 31024
diff changeset
3401 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
33411
a873b191d4c5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 33373
diff changeset
3402 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
a873b191d4c5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 33373
diff changeset
3403 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
29218
e956cc90f6c0 newcomment and the change of binding for M-;
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 29162
diff changeset
3404
28799
94a120630e7d display-time stuff
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28789
diff changeset
3405 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
94a120630e7d display-time stuff
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28789
diff changeset
3406 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
94a120630e7d display-time stuff
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28789
diff changeset
3407 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
94a120630e7d display-time stuff
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28789
diff changeset
3408 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
94a120630e7d display-time stuff
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28789
diff changeset
3409
28695
3930c7410fd6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28677
diff changeset
3410 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
3930c7410fd6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28677
diff changeset
3411 on the display using several methods
3930c7410fd6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28677
diff changeset
3412
3930c7410fd6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28677
diff changeset
3413 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
3930c7410fd6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28677
diff changeset
3414 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
3930c7410fd6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28677
diff changeset
3415 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
3930c7410fd6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28677
diff changeset
3416
3930c7410fd6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28677
diff changeset
3417 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
33838
415baa3f1914 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 33796
diff changeset
3418 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
28695
3930c7410fd6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28677
diff changeset
3419
28870
b3629cc23098 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28855
diff changeset
3420 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
28695
3930c7410fd6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28677
diff changeset
3421
3930c7410fd6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28677
diff changeset
3422 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
3930c7410fd6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28677
diff changeset
3423 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
3930c7410fd6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28677
diff changeset
3424
29752
76ef59b86226 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29696
diff changeset
3425 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
28660
9de15cb0c24b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28658
diff changeset
3426 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
29752
76ef59b86226 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29696
diff changeset
3427 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
28660
9de15cb0c24b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28658
diff changeset
3428 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
28626
79911b5afa95 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28556
diff changeset
3429
28525
05658544eaff backup-directory-alist, make-backup-file-name-function.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28506
diff changeset
3430 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
28757
2fb6dbfe29f6 concat change
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28751
diff changeset
3431 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
2fb6dbfe29f6 concat change
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28751
diff changeset
3432 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
28525
05658544eaff backup-directory-alist, make-backup-file-name-function.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28506
diff changeset
3433
28396
225ae57ab78e iso-iso2sgml
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28335
diff changeset
3434 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
225ae57ab78e iso-iso2sgml
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28335
diff changeset
3435 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
225ae57ab78e iso-iso2sgml
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28335
diff changeset
3436
28159
20862b49300f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28149
diff changeset
3437 ** New X resources recognized
27994
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3438
28140
343d3197bdea *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28132
diff changeset
3439 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
343d3197bdea *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28132
diff changeset
3440 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
343d3197bdea *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28132
diff changeset
3441 is useful for debugging X problems.
343d3197bdea *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28132
diff changeset
3442
343d3197bdea *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28132
diff changeset
3443 Example:
343d3197bdea *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28132
diff changeset
3444
28159
20862b49300f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28149
diff changeset
3445 emacs.synchronous: true
28140
343d3197bdea *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28132
diff changeset
3446
27994
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3447 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3448 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
27995
82c488f26a07 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27994
diff changeset
3449 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
82c488f26a07 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27994
diff changeset
3450 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
82c488f26a07 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27994
diff changeset
3451 visual class names are
27994
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3452
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3453 TrueColor
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3454 PseudoColor
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3455 DirectColor
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3456 StaticColor
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3457 GrayScale
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3458 StaticGray
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3459
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3460 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3461 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3462 meaning.
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3463
27995
82c488f26a07 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27994
diff changeset
3464 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
82c488f26a07 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27994
diff changeset
3465 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
82c488f26a07 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27994
diff changeset
3466 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
82c488f26a07 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27994
diff changeset
3467 visual.
82c488f26a07 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27994
diff changeset
3468
82c488f26a07 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27994
diff changeset
3469 Example:
82c488f26a07 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27994
diff changeset
3470
28159
20862b49300f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28149
diff changeset
3471 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
27994
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3472
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3473 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3474 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3475 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3476 resource values are `true' or `on'.
0ef07a7894e2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27966
diff changeset
3477
27995
82c488f26a07 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27994
diff changeset
3478 Example:
82c488f26a07 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27994
diff changeset
3479
28159
20862b49300f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28149
diff changeset
3480 emacs.privateColormap: true
27995
82c488f26a07 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27994
diff changeset
3481
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3482 ** Faces and frame parameters.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3483
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3484 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3485 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3486 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3487 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3488 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3489 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3490 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3491
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3492 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3493 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
3494 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3495 `default' face and vice versa.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3496
25951
b3f0ced6423b Add entry for face `menu'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25949
diff changeset
3497 ** New face `menu'.
b3f0ced6423b Add entry for face `menu'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25949
diff changeset
3498
b3f0ced6423b Add entry for face `menu'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25949
diff changeset
3499 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
b3f0ced6423b Add entry for face `menu'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25949
diff changeset
3500
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3501 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3502
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3503 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3504 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3505 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3506 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3507
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3508 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3509 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3510 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3511
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3512 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3513 `ScreenGamma'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3514
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3515 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3516
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3517 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3518 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3519 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3520 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3521
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3522 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3523
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3524 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3525
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3526 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3527
28677
950ff4674e17 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 28660
diff changeset
3528 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
950ff4674e17 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 28660
diff changeset
3529 LessTif/Motif one.
950ff4674e17 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 28660
diff changeset
3530
950ff4674e17 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 28660
diff changeset
3531 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
950ff4674e17 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 28660
diff changeset
3532 LessTif and Motif.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3533
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3534 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3535
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3536 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3537 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3538 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3539
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3540 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3541 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3542
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3543 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3544 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3545 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3546
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3547 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3548
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3549 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
33624
a4bef8dfb930 *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 33620
diff changeset
3550 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3551 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
31124
265c24a487bf *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31073
diff changeset
3552 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3553
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3554 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
35680
1a6073992224 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35665
diff changeset
3555 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3556 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
31124
265c24a487bf *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31073
diff changeset
3557 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3558
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3559 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3560 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3561 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3562 buffers.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3563
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3564 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3565
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3566 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3567 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3568 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3569
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3570 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3571 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3572 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3573 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3574 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3575 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3576
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3577 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3578
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3579 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3580 notably at the end of lines.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3581
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3582 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3583 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3584
37446
1b121f2746a8 Change entries for string-rectangle and alike.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37388
diff changeset
3585 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
1b121f2746a8 Change entries for string-rectangle and alike.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37388
diff changeset
3586
1b121f2746a8 Change entries for string-rectangle and alike.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37388
diff changeset
3587 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
1b121f2746a8 Change entries for string-rectangle and alike.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37388
diff changeset
3588 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
35640
6ed788afc91f Document the incompatible change in string-rectangle.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35578
diff changeset
3589
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3590 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3591 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3592 after each match to get the replacement text.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3593
29972
39c1579e89a8 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29962
diff changeset
3594 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
39c1579e89a8 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29962
diff changeset
3595 you edit the replacement string.
28805
d77e34df755e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28799
diff changeset
3596
38925
d5d4948816a7 Label all user-level changes with either +++ or ---.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38900
diff changeset
3597 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
d5d4948816a7 Label all user-level changes with either +++ or ---.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38900
diff changeset
3598 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
d5d4948816a7 Label all user-level changes with either +++ or ---.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38900
diff changeset
3599 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
28805
d77e34df755e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28799
diff changeset
3600
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3601 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3602
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3603 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3604 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3605
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3606 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3607 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3608 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3609 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3610
38925
d5d4948816a7 Label all user-level changes with either +++ or ---.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38900
diff changeset
3611 --
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3612 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3613 read mail from the menu etc.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3614
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3615 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3616 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3617 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3618 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3619
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3620 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3621 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3622
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3623 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3624 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3625 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3626 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3627 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3628 of Emacs.
29676
6c84e790448f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29657
diff changeset
3629
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3630 ** Customize changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3631
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3632 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
36885
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
3633 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
3634 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
3635 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
3636 earlier versions of Emacs.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3637
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3638 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3639 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3640 default).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3641
37901
9447d0447996 Document that customizations from "emacs -q" cannot be saved.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37805
diff changeset
3642 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
9447d0447996 Document that customizations from "emacs -q" cannot be saved.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37805
diff changeset
3643 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
9447d0447996 Document that customizations from "emacs -q" cannot be saved.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37805
diff changeset
3644 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
9447d0447996 Document that customizations from "emacs -q" cannot be saved.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37805
diff changeset
3645 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
9447d0447996 Document that customizations from "emacs -q" cannot be saved.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37805
diff changeset
3646 file.
9447d0447996 Document that customizations from "emacs -q" cannot be saved.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37805
diff changeset
3647
43061
357ce0fca815 Document the new behavior of novice.el under "emacs -q".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43045
diff changeset
3648 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
357ce0fca815 Document the new behavior of novice.el under "emacs -q".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43045
diff changeset
3649 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
357ce0fca815 Document the new behavior of novice.el under "emacs -q".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43045
diff changeset
3650 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
357ce0fca815 Document the new behavior of novice.el under "emacs -q".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43045
diff changeset
3651 already in your init file.
357ce0fca815 Document the new behavior of novice.el under "emacs -q".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43045
diff changeset
3652
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3653 ** New features in evaluation commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3654
30056
2381ee2fec5b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30038
diff changeset
3655 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3656 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
38562
5a192d819ce2 Mention the effect of eval-expression-print-length and
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38527
diff changeset
3657 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3658 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3659 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3660
38562
5a192d819ce2 Mention the effect of eval-expression-print-length and
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38527
diff changeset
3661 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
5a192d819ce2 Mention the effect of eval-expression-print-length and
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38527
diff changeset
3662 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
5a192d819ce2 Mention the effect of eval-expression-print-length and
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38527
diff changeset
3663 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
5a192d819ce2 Mention the effect of eval-expression-print-length and
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38527
diff changeset
3664 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
5a192d819ce2 Mention the effect of eval-expression-print-length and
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38527
diff changeset
3665 printed).
5a192d819ce2 Mention the effect of eval-expression-print-length and
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38527
diff changeset
3666
38590
7c2e49c3cf0a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38573
diff changeset
3667 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
7c2e49c3cf0a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38573
diff changeset
3668 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
38573
37d0e44d564c *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38562
diff changeset
3669
38562
5a192d819ce2 Mention the effect of eval-expression-print-length and
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38527
diff changeset
3670 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
5a192d819ce2 Mention the effect of eval-expression-print-length and
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38527
diff changeset
3671 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
5a192d819ce2 Mention the effect of eval-expression-print-length and
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38527
diff changeset
3672
40526
b466f4f946a7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40493
diff changeset
3673 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
30056
2381ee2fec5b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30038
diff changeset
3674 code when called with a prefix argument.
2381ee2fec5b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30038
diff changeset
3675
26820
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3676 ** CC mode changes.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3677
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3678 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3679 current user setups (although it's believed that these
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3680 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3681 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3682 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3683 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3684 release.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3685
37009
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3686 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3687 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3688 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3689 confusion.
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3690
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3691 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3692 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3693 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3694 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3695
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3696 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3697 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3698
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3699 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3700 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3701
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3702 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3703 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3704 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3705 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3706
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3707 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3708 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3709 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3710 earlier statement. An example:
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3711
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3712 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3713 if (a[i])
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3714 res += a[i]->offset;
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3715 else
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3716
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3717 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3718 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3719 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3720 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3721 the preceding "if".
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3722
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3723 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3724 by default.
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3725
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3726 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3727 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3728 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3729 documentation or other natural language text.
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3730
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3731 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3732 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3733 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3734 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3735 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3736 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3737 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3738
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3739 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3740 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3741 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3742 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3743
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3744 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3745 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3746 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3747 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3748 Pike mode only.
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3749
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3750 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3751 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3752 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3753 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3754 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3755 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3756 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3757 is reported afterwards.
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3758
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3759 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3760 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3761 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3762
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3763 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3764 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3765 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3766 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3767 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3768 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3769 groundwork.
cceb6b28e250 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36917
diff changeset
3770
30412
527532050288 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30372
diff changeset
3771 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
527532050288 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30372
diff changeset
3772 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
527532050288 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30372
diff changeset
3773 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
527532050288 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30372
diff changeset
3774 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
527532050288 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30372
diff changeset
3775 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
527532050288 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30372
diff changeset
3776 have to bother.
527532050288 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30372
diff changeset
3777
527532050288 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30372
diff changeset
3778 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
527532050288 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30372
diff changeset
3779 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
30445
507cbd3f9296 Fix a typo.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 30415
diff changeset
3780 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
30412
527532050288 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30372
diff changeset
3781 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
527532050288 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30372
diff changeset
3782 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
527532050288 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30372
diff changeset
3783 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
527532050288 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30372
diff changeset
3784
26820
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3785 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3786 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3787 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3788 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3789 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3790 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3791 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3792 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3793
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3794 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3795 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3796 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3797 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3798 above.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3799
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3800 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3801 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3802 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3803 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3804 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3805 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3806 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3807 function documentation for more info.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3808
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3809 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3810 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3811 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3812 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3813 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3814 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3815 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3816 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3817
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3818 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3819
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3820 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3821 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3822
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3823 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3824 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3825 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3826 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3827 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3828 style system.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3829
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3830 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3831 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3832 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3833 as far as possible.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3834
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3835 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3836 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3837 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3838 chapter about this in the manual.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3839
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3840 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3841 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3842 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3843 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3844 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3845
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3846 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3847 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3848 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3849
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3850 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3851 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3852
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3853 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3854 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3855 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3856 inside CC Mode.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3857
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3858 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3859 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3860 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3861 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3862 cc-mode/).
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3863
38894
681dc47ffb61 Document the removal of c-hanging-comment-starter-p and
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38832
diff changeset
3864 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
681dc47ffb61 Document the removal of c-hanging-comment-starter-p and
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38832
diff changeset
3865 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
681dc47ffb61 Document the removal of c-hanging-comment-starter-p and
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38832
diff changeset
3866 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
681dc47ffb61 Document the removal of c-hanging-comment-starter-p and
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38832
diff changeset
3867 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
681dc47ffb61 Document the removal of c-hanging-comment-starter-p and
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38832
diff changeset
3868 they were before the filling.
681dc47ffb61 Document the removal of c-hanging-comment-starter-p and
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38832
diff changeset
3869
26820
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3870 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3871 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3872 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3873 literals.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3874
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3875 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3876 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3877 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3878 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3879 this function.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3880
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3881 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3882 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3883 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3884 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3885 Thanks to Eric Eide.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3886
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3887 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3888 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3889 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3890
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3891 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3892
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3893 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3894 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3895 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3896 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3897
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3898 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3899 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3900 the column specified by comment-column.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3901
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3902 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3903 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3904 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3905 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3906 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3907 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3908
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3909 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3910 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3911 arguments.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3912
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3913 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3914
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3915 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3916 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3917 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3918 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3919 Provan).
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3920
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3921 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
b7d914dd51a6 cc-mode changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26786
diff changeset
3922
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3923 ** Dired changes
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3924
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3925 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3926 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3927 is, delete only empty directories.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3928
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3929 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3930 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3931 copy directories recursively.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3932
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3933 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3934 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3935 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3936
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3937 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3938 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3939 directory.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3940
38989
6dcbf4154ff0 Change key for dired-show-file-type to `y'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38938
diff changeset
3941 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3942 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3943 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3944 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3945 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3946
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3947 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3948 from ls switches.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3949
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3950 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3951 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3952 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3953 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3954
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3955 ** Gnus changes.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3956
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3957 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3958 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3959 internationalization and mail-fetching.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3960
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3961 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3962 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3963
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3964 If you used procmail like in
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3965
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3966 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3967 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3968 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3969 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3970
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3971 this now has changed to
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3972
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3973 (setq mail-sources
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3974 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3975 :suffix ".in")))
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3976
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3977 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3978 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3979
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3980 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3981 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3982 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3983 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3984
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3985 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3986 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3987 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3988
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3989 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3990 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3991 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3992 now just a compatibility layer.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3993
38925
d5d4948816a7 Label all user-level changes with either +++ or ---.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38900
diff changeset
3994 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
d5d4948816a7 Label all user-level changes with either +++ or ---.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38900
diff changeset
3995 Gnus facilities.
d5d4948816a7 Label all user-level changes with either +++ or ---.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38900
diff changeset
3996
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3997 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3998 called to position point.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
3999
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4000 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4001 summary buffers and NOV files.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4002
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4003 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4004 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4005
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4006 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4007 subtly different manner.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4008
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4009 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4010 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4011 ever-changing layouts.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4012
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4013 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4014
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4015 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4016
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4017 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4018
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4019 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4020 macros
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4021
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4022 Key binding Macro
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4023 -------------------------
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4024 C-c C-c C-s @strong
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4025 C-c C-c C-e @emph
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4026 C-c C-c u @uref
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4027 C-c C-c q @quotation
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4028 C-c C-c m @email
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4029 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4030 M-RET @item
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4031
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4032 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4033
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4034 ** Changes in Outline mode.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4035
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4036 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4037 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4038 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4039
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4040 ** Changes to Emacs Server
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4041
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4042 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4043 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4044 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4045 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4046 buffers to kill, as before.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4047
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4048 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4049 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4050 this way.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4051
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4052 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4053 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4054
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4055 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4056
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4057 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4058 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4059 use. Default is 1000.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4060
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4061 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4062 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4063
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4064 ** Changes to hideshow.el
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4065
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4066 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4067
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4068 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4069 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4070 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4071 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4072
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4073 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4074 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4075 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4076 the open block.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4077
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4078 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4079 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4080 the normal block-hiding function.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4081
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4082 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4083
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4084 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4085 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4086 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4087 for `hs-minor-mode'.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4088
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4089 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4090 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4091
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4092 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4093
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4094 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4095 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4096 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4097
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4098 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4099 current buffer.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4100
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4101 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4102 in a log file.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4103
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4104 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4105 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4106 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4107 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4108 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4109 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4110
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4111 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4112
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4113 ** Changes to cmuscheme
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4114
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4115 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4116 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4117
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4118 ** Changes in Font Lock
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4119
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4120 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4121 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4122
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4123 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4124 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4125
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4126 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4127 the face used for each string/comment.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4128
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4129 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4130 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4131
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4132 ** Changes to Shell mode
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4133
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4134 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4135 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4136 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4137 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4138
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4139 ** Comint (subshell) changes
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4140
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4141 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4142 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4143
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4144 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4145 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4146 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4147 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4148 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4149 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4150
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4151 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4152 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4153 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4154 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4155 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4156 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4157 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4158 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4159
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4160 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4161 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4162
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4163 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4164 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4165 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4166
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4167 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4168 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4169 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4170
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4171 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4172 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4173 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4174
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4175 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4176 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4177 argument, it appends to the file.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4178
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4179 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4180 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4181 compatibility.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4182
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4183 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4184 ring (history).
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4185
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4186 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4187 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4188 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4189
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4190 ** Changes to Rmail mode
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4191
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4192 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4193 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4194 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4195 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4196 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4197 as correspondent.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4198
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4199 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4200 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4201 regexp matching your mail addresses.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4202
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4203 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4204 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4205 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4206 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4207 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4208
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4209 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4210 like `j'.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4211
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4212 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4213 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4214 digest message.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4215
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4216 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4217 in which folder to put messages automatically.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4218
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4219 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4220 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4221 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4222
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4223 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4224 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4225
38925
d5d4948816a7 Label all user-level changes with either +++ or ---.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38900
diff changeset
4226 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
d5d4948816a7 Label all user-level changes with either +++ or ---.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38900
diff changeset
4227 use the -f option when sending mail.
d5d4948816a7 Label all user-level changes with either +++ or ---.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38900
diff changeset
4228
39300
8b178b9f2ee1 Document that rmail-output-to-rmail-file now writes in emacs-mule.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39270
diff changeset
4229 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
8b178b9f2ee1 Document that rmail-output-to-rmail-file now writes in emacs-mule.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39270
diff changeset
4230 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
8b178b9f2ee1 Document that rmail-output-to-rmail-file now writes in emacs-mule.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39270
diff changeset
4231 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
8b178b9f2ee1 Document that rmail-output-to-rmail-file now writes in emacs-mule.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39270
diff changeset
4232 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
8b178b9f2ee1 Document that rmail-output-to-rmail-file now writes in emacs-mule.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39270
diff changeset
4233 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
8b178b9f2ee1 Document that rmail-output-to-rmail-file now writes in emacs-mule.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39270
diff changeset
4234 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
8b178b9f2ee1 Document that rmail-output-to-rmail-file now writes in emacs-mule.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39270
diff changeset
4235
8b178b9f2ee1 Document that rmail-output-to-rmail-file now writes in emacs-mule.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39270
diff changeset
4236 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
8b178b9f2ee1 Document that rmail-output-to-rmail-file now writes in emacs-mule.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39270
diff changeset
4237 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
8b178b9f2ee1 Document that rmail-output-to-rmail-file now writes in emacs-mule.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39270
diff changeset
4238 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
8b178b9f2ee1 Document that rmail-output-to-rmail-file now writes in emacs-mule.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39270
diff changeset
4239
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4240 ** Changes to TeX mode
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4241
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4242 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4243 `latex-mode'.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4244
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4245 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4246
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4247 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4248
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4249 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4250
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4251 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4252
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4253 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4254 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4255 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4256 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4257 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4258 can be edited from that buffer.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4259
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4260 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4261 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4262 `A' to use all marked entries).
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4263
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4264 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4265 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4266
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4267 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4268 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4269 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4270 been cited.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4271
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4272 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4273 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4274 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4275 in column 1 are always made leaves.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4276
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4277 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4278 has the following new features:
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4279
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4280 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4281 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4282 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4283 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4284
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4285 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4286 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4287 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4288 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4289 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4290 defaults to 1.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4291
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4292 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4293 file names.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4294
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4295 ** Ispell changes
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4296
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4297 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4298 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4299 spell-checks the current buffer.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4300
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4301 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4302 added.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4303
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4304 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4305 correction is made and re-checked.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4306
49799
8cdcf1a04744 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49766
diff changeset
4307 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4308
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4309 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4310 cases.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4311
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4312 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4313 on syntax errors.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4314
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4315 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4316 end of the buffer.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4317
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4318 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4319
28506
3d557619ba03 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28496
diff changeset
4320 ** Makefile mode changes
3d557619ba03 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28496
diff changeset
4321
3d557619ba03 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28496
diff changeset
4322 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
3d557619ba03 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28496
diff changeset
4323
30483
05fc373ff5b8 mention `float-time' and the remote file modtime check
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 30482
diff changeset
4324 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
28506
3d557619ba03 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28496
diff changeset
4325 Fontlock mode is active.
3d557619ba03 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28496
diff changeset
4326
26407
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4327 ** Isearch changes
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4328
30477
5996e9860cd2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30467
diff changeset
4329 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
5996e9860cd2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30467
diff changeset
4330 so that searches can be resumed.
5996e9860cd2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30467
diff changeset
4331
40526
b466f4f946a7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40493
diff changeset
4332 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
28506
3d557619ba03 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28496
diff changeset
4333 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
3d557619ba03 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28496
diff changeset
4334 that started the search.
3d557619ba03 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28496
diff changeset
4335
26407
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4336 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4337 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4338
26407
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4339 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4340
26417
5678b244c3ac Changes in `list-buffers'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26407
diff changeset
4341 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
26407
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4342 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4343 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4344 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4345 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
30483
05fc373ff5b8 mention `float-time' and the remote file modtime check
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 30482
diff changeset
4346 `secondary-selection'.
26407
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4347
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4348 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4349 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4350 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4351 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4352 usual snappy response.
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4353
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4354 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4355 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4356 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4357 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
ef48fc763e7f Isearch lazy highlight
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26403
diff changeset
4358
31388
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4359 ** VC Changes
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4360
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4361 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4362 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4363 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4364 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4365 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
36275
44540d398934 Some corrections to the VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36259
diff changeset
4366 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
31388
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4367 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4368 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4369 file is registered in that backend.
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4370
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4371 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4372 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4373 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4374 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4375 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4376 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4377
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4378 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4379 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4380 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4381 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4382 where it doesn't make sense.)
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4383
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4384 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4385 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4386 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4387
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4388 *** General Changes
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4389
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4390 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4391 checks are always done now.
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4392
31858
269d69b69fe4 Update hideshow.el section.
Thien-Thi Nguyen <ttn@gnuvola.org>
parents: 31827
diff changeset
4393 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
31388
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4394 operations.
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4395
33111
bbf383648e4d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 33020
diff changeset
4396 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
bbf383648e4d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 33020
diff changeset
4397 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
bbf383648e4d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 33020
diff changeset
4398 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
bbf383648e4d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 33020
diff changeset
4399
33541
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4400 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4401 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4402 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4403 the working file (``merge news'').
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4404
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4405 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4406 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4407 downwards.
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4408
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4409 *** Multiple Backends
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4410
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4411 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4412 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4413 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4414 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4415 local RCS archives.
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4416
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4417 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4418 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4419 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4420 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4421
36275
44540d398934 Some corrections to the VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36259
diff changeset
4422 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
44540d398934 Some corrections to the VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36259
diff changeset
4423 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
44540d398934 Some corrections to the VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36259
diff changeset
4424 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
44540d398934 Some corrections to the VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36259
diff changeset
4425 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
44540d398934 Some corrections to the VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36259
diff changeset
4426 current revision number from the more remote backend.
33541
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4427
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4428 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4429 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4430 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4431 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4432
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4433 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4434 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4435 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4436 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4437
31388
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4438 *** Changes for CVS
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4439
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4440 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4441 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4442 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4443 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4444 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4445 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4446 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4447
33541
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4448 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4449 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4450 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4451 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4452 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4453 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4454 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4455 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4456 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
33862
09fdef086f4d C-c C-c u in Texinfo now produces @uref, not @url.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 33838
diff changeset
4457 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
09fdef086f4d C-c C-c u in Texinfo now produces @uref, not @url.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 33838
diff changeset
4458 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
09fdef086f4d C-c C-c u in Texinfo now produces @uref, not @url.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 33838
diff changeset
4459 name.)
33541
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4460
31388
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4461 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4462 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4463 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
33541
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4464 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
31388
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4465 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4466 entire directory tree.
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4467
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4468 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4469 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4470 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4471 "watched" by other developers.)
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4472
33541
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4473 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4474 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
36275
44540d398934 Some corrections to the VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36259
diff changeset
4475 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
33541
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4476 starting at the given directory.
3542a106155f Updated VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 33499
diff changeset
4477
31388
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4478 *** Lisp Changes in VC
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4479
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4480 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4481 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4482 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4483 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
36275
44540d398934 Some corrections to the VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36259
diff changeset
4484 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
44540d398934 Some corrections to the VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36259
diff changeset
4485 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
31388
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4486 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
36275
44540d398934 Some corrections to the VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36259
diff changeset
4487 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
44540d398934 Some corrections to the VC news.
André Spiegel <spiegel@gnu.org>
parents: 36259
diff changeset
4488 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
31388
c0199a9a07fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31279
diff changeset
4489
36525
cb77fd8249b6 Change the `***' for the EDT entry to `**'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36470
diff changeset
4490 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
35163
2aa481613ac4 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35162
diff changeset
4491 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
2aa481613ac4 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35162
diff changeset
4492 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
2aa481613ac4 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35162
diff changeset
4493 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
2aa481613ac4 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35162
diff changeset
4494
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4495 ** New modes and packages
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4496
34394
d6a4dd5cd345 Entry for `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 34389
diff changeset
4497 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
d6a4dd5cd345 Entry for `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 34389
diff changeset
4498 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
d6a4dd5cd345 Entry for `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 34389
diff changeset
4499 the default is not applicable.
d6a4dd5cd345 Entry for `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 34389
diff changeset
4500
33618
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4501 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4502 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4503 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4504
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4505 Features are:
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4506
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4507 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4508 drawn, like this: | \ /
33796
10ffa5b56f53 mention `delete-trailing-whitespace'
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 33720
diff changeset
4509 --+-- X
33618
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4510 | / \
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4511
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4512 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4513 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4514 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4515 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4516 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4517 you are drawing.
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4518
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4519 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4520 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4521
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4522 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4523 flood-filling.
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4524
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4525 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4526 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4527 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4528 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
33796
10ffa5b56f53 mention `delete-trailing-whitespace'
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 33720
diff changeset
4529
33618
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4530 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4531 also do without the mouse.
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4532
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4533 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4534 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4535 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4536 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4537 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4538
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4539 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4540
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4541 lines straight-lines
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4542 rectangles squares
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4543 poly-lines straight poly-lines
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4544 ellipses circles
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4545 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4546 spray-can setting size for spraying
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4547 vaporize line vaporize lines
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4548 erase characters erase rectangles
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4549
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4550 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4551 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4552 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4553 drawing.
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4554
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4555 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4556 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4557 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4558 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4559
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4560 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4561 can be turned off).
beb961476e7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33559
diff changeset
4562
32448
4925b241a9ac Added a note about Eshell.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 32428
diff changeset
4563 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
4925b241a9ac Added a note about Eshell.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 32428
diff changeset
4564 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
4925b241a9ac Added a note about Eshell.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 32428
diff changeset
4565 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
4925b241a9ac Added a note about Eshell.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 32428
diff changeset
4566 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
4925b241a9ac Added a note about Eshell.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 32428
diff changeset
4567 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
4925b241a9ac Added a note about Eshell.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 32428
diff changeset
4568 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
4925b241a9ac Added a note about Eshell.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 32428
diff changeset
4569 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
4925b241a9ac Added a note about Eshell.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 32428
diff changeset
4570 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
4925b241a9ac Added a note about Eshell.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 32428
diff changeset
4571 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
4925b241a9ac Added a note about Eshell.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 32428
diff changeset
4572
30781
59479ef35bf2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30776
diff changeset
4573 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
59479ef35bf2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30776
diff changeset
4574 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
59479ef35bf2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30776
diff changeset
4575 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
59479ef35bf2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30776
diff changeset
4576 on certain projects.
59479ef35bf2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30776
diff changeset
4577
35927
f41b5b91e80d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35923
diff changeset
4578 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
f41b5b91e80d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35923
diff changeset
4579 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
30789
68b63779f4df typo fix
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 30788
diff changeset
4580
68b63779f4df typo fix
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 30788
diff changeset
4581 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
30565
338238ca63ce *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30564
diff changeset
4582
338238ca63ce *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30564
diff changeset
4583 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
338238ca63ce *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30564
diff changeset
4584 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
338238ca63ce *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30564
diff changeset
4585 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
338238ca63ce *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30564
diff changeset
4586 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
338238ca63ce *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30564
diff changeset
4587 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
338238ca63ce *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30564
diff changeset
4588 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
35927
f41b5b91e80d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35923
diff changeset
4589 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
f41b5b91e80d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35923
diff changeset
4590 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
30565
338238ca63ce *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30564
diff changeset
4591
30789
68b63779f4df typo fix
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 30788
diff changeset
4592 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
30565
338238ca63ce *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30564
diff changeset
4593 Emacs is idle.
338238ca63ce *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30564
diff changeset
4594
38099
3255cb9d0be2 Mention tildify.el.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38067
diff changeset
4595 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
3255cb9d0be2 Mention tildify.el.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38067
diff changeset
4596 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
3255cb9d0be2 Mention tildify.el.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38067
diff changeset
4597
30319
c84efa0acd91 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30305
diff changeset
4598 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
c84efa0acd91 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30305
diff changeset
4599 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
c84efa0acd91 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30305
diff changeset
4600
29218
e956cc90f6c0 newcomment and the change of binding for M-;
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 29162
diff changeset
4601 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
e956cc90f6c0 newcomment and the change of binding for M-;
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 29162
diff changeset
4602 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
e956cc90f6c0 newcomment and the change of binding for M-;
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 29162
diff changeset
4603 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
33913
0c780fd30da5 New font-lock-doc-face.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 33862
diff changeset
4604 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
0c780fd30da5 New font-lock-doc-face.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 33862
diff changeset
4605 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
29218
e956cc90f6c0 newcomment and the change of binding for M-;
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 29162
diff changeset
4606
28879
2a918425ca15 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28870
diff changeset
4607 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
2a918425ca15 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28870
diff changeset
4608 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
2a918425ca15 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28870
diff changeset
4609 separate Texinfo file.
2a918425ca15 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28870
diff changeset
4610
31007
0e3404fe9965 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31004
diff changeset
4611 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
0e3404fe9965 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31004
diff changeset
4612 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
0e3404fe9965 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31004
diff changeset
4613 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
0e3404fe9965 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31004
diff changeset
4614 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
35680
1a6073992224 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35665
diff changeset
4615 enter check-in log messages.
31007
0e3404fe9965 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31004
diff changeset
4616
28834
636c8cafb7d4 Mention `woman'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 28805
diff changeset
4617 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
636c8cafb7d4 Mention `woman'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 28805
diff changeset
4618 without invoking external programs.
636c8cafb7d4 Mention `woman'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 28805
diff changeset
4619
636c8cafb7d4 Mention `woman'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 28805
diff changeset
4620 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
636c8cafb7d4 Mention `woman'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 28805
diff changeset
4621 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
636c8cafb7d4 Mention `woman'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 28805
diff changeset
4622 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
636c8cafb7d4 Mention `woman'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 28805
diff changeset
4623 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
28955
6cfd3ddf0911 Correct a typo in description of `woman.el'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 28946
diff changeset
4624 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
28834
636c8cafb7d4 Mention `woman'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 28805
diff changeset
4625
636c8cafb7d4 Mention `woman'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 28805
diff changeset
4626 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
636c8cafb7d4 Mention `woman'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 28805
diff changeset
4627 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
636c8cafb7d4 Mention `woman'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 28805
diff changeset
4628
28098
2fc1959fa99d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28094
diff changeset
4629 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
2fc1959fa99d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28094
diff changeset
4630 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
2fc1959fa99d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28094
diff changeset
4631
2fc1959fa99d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28094
diff changeset
4632 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
2fc1959fa99d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28094
diff changeset
4633 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
2fc1959fa99d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28094
diff changeset
4634 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
2fc1959fa99d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28094
diff changeset
4635 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
2fc1959fa99d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28094
diff changeset
4636 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
2fc1959fa99d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28094
diff changeset
4637 single step.
2fc1959fa99d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28094
diff changeset
4638
2fc1959fa99d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28094
diff changeset
4639 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
2fc1959fa99d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28094
diff changeset
4640 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
2fc1959fa99d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28094
diff changeset
4641 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
2fc1959fa99d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28094
diff changeset
4642 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
2fc1959fa99d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28094
diff changeset
4643
27644
1ac28043dbd6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27573
diff changeset
4644 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
1ac28043dbd6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27573
diff changeset
4645 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
1ac28043dbd6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27573
diff changeset
4646 actually modifying content of a buffer.
1ac28043dbd6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27573
diff changeset
4647
27498
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4648 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4649 PostScript.
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4650
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4651 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4652
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4653 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4654
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4655 ; comment (until end of line)
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4656 A non-terminal
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4657 "C" terminal
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4658 ?C? special
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4659 $A default non-terminal
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4660 $"C" default terminal
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4661 $?C? default special
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4662 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4663 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4664 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4665 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4666 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4667 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4668 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4669 C+ one or more occurrences of C
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4670 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4671 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4672 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4673 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4674 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4675 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4676 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4677
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4678 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
960ea40c1a7e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27475
diff changeset
4679
27328
7748234c70d7 align.el
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27307
diff changeset
4680 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
7748234c70d7 align.el
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27307
diff changeset
4681 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
7748234c70d7 align.el
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27307
diff changeset
4682 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
7748234c70d7 align.el
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27307
diff changeset
4683 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
7748234c70d7 align.el
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27307
diff changeset
4684 equal signs of assignments.
7748234c70d7 align.el
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27307
diff changeset
4685
27266
8ce11c7a7fcb read-mail-command, outline mode changes, change-log-merge,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27200
diff changeset
4686 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
8ce11c7a7fcb read-mail-command, outline mode changes, change-log-merge,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27200
diff changeset
4687 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
8ce11c7a7fcb read-mail-command, outline mode changes, change-log-merge,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27200
diff changeset
4688
27016
62cd5f1749cc *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27005
diff changeset
4689 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
62cd5f1749cc *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27005
diff changeset
4690 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
36885
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
4691 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
27016
62cd5f1749cc *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27005
diff changeset
4692
29696
a5051216d618 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29676
diff changeset
4693 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
a5051216d618 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29676
diff changeset
4694
27733
d6a89b95b32d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27714
diff changeset
4695 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
d6a89b95b32d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27714
diff changeset
4696 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
d6a89b95b32d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27714
diff changeset
4697 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
d6a89b95b32d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27714
diff changeset
4698 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
d6a89b95b32d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27714
diff changeset
4699 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
d6a89b95b32d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27714
diff changeset
4700 which answers different needs.
d6a89b95b32d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27714
diff changeset
4701
26964
2939daf50656 Font-lock changes by Anders Lindgren.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26933
diff changeset
4702 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
2939daf50656 Font-lock changes by Anders Lindgren.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26933
diff changeset
4703 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
2939daf50656 Font-lock changes by Anders Lindgren.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26933
diff changeset
4704 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
2939daf50656 Font-lock changes by Anders Lindgren.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26933
diff changeset
4705 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
2939daf50656 Font-lock changes by Anders Lindgren.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26933
diff changeset
4706 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
2939daf50656 Font-lock changes by Anders Lindgren.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26933
diff changeset
4707 to be enabled.
2939daf50656 Font-lock changes by Anders Lindgren.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26933
diff changeset
4708
27094
6500fd0a7d8e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 27092
diff changeset
4709 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
6500fd0a7d8e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 27092
diff changeset
4710 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
6500fd0a7d8e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 27092
diff changeset
4711
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4712 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4713
38938
0815e13f099e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38925
diff changeset
4714 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
0815e13f099e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38925
diff changeset
4715 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
46989
eeab5bdaffa2 Fix typos.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46962
diff changeset
4716 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4717
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4718 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4719
35578
f499794dc393 flyspell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35577
diff changeset
4720 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
31936
3d17044d63a9 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31924
diff changeset
4721 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
3d17044d63a9 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31924
diff changeset
4722 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
3d17044d63a9 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31924
diff changeset
4723 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
3d17044d63a9 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31924
diff changeset
4724 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
3d17044d63a9 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31924
diff changeset
4725 and background colors.
3d17044d63a9 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31924
diff changeset
4726
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4727 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4728 Pascal) language.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4729
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4730 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4731 the text at point.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4732
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4733 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4734
25862
62b8ede0e424 Mention fortune.el.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 25853
diff changeset
4735 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
62b8ede0e424 Mention fortune.el.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 25853
diff changeset
4736
35163
2aa481613ac4 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35162
diff changeset
4737 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
2aa481613ac4 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35162
diff changeset
4738 whitespace in a file.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4739
25992
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4740 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4741 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4742 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4743 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4744 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4745 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4746 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4747
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4748 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4749
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4750 Here is an example of columns:
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4751
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4752 horse apple bus
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4753 dog pineapple car EXTRA
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4754 porcupine strawberry airplane
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4755
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4756 Doing the following settings:
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4757
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4758 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4759 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4760 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4761 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4762
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4763
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4764 Selecting the lines above and typing:
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4765
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4766 M-x delimit-columns-region
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4767
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4768 It results:
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4769
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4770 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4771 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4772 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4773
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4774 delim-col has the following options:
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4775
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4776 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4777 before all columns.
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4778
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4779 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4780 between each column.
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4781
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4782 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4783 after all columns.
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4784
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4785 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4786 each column.
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4787
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4788 delim-col has the following commands:
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4789
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4790 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4791 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
8f40394739f2 Add sh-script changes.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25984
diff changeset
4792
36885
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
4793 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
4794 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
4795 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
4796 recent file list can be displayed:
30319
c84efa0acd91 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30305
diff changeset
4797
c84efa0acd91 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30305
diff changeset
4798 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
35680
1a6073992224 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35665
diff changeset
4799 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
1a6073992224 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35665
diff changeset
4800 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
30319
c84efa0acd91 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30305
diff changeset
4801
c84efa0acd91 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30305
diff changeset
4802 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
c84efa0acd91 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30305
diff changeset
4803 dynamically change the menu appearance.
26030
c5e8559a53cb Add description of recentf.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26016
diff changeset
4804
26149
0a342d5afcc2 elide-head.el
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26144
diff changeset
4805 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
0a342d5afcc2 elide-head.el
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26144
diff changeset
4806 text.
0a342d5afcc2 elide-head.el
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26144
diff changeset
4807
26924
5348841810f6 Add diff-mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26835
diff changeset
4808 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
26786
d30b640777b8 footnote.el
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26768
diff changeset
4809 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
d30b640777b8 footnote.el
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26768
diff changeset
4810 specific to Message mode.
d30b640777b8 footnote.el
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26768
diff changeset
4811
26924
5348841810f6 Add diff-mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26835
diff changeset
4812 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
5348841810f6 Add diff-mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26835
diff changeset
4813 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
5348841810f6 Add diff-mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26835
diff changeset
4814 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
5348841810f6 Add diff-mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26835
diff changeset
4815
27714
22a581e00fe4 Mention some new packages, extra configure options.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27693
diff changeset
4816 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
22a581e00fe4 Mention some new packages, extra configure options.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27693
diff changeset
4817 interface to access directory servers using different directory
22a581e00fe4 Mention some new packages, extra configure options.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27693
diff changeset
4818 protocols. It has a separate manual.
22a581e00fe4 Mention some new packages, extra configure options.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27693
diff changeset
4819
28132
2a26c31d59c5 replace-rectangle, autoconf.el
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28098
diff changeset
4820 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
2a26c31d59c5 replace-rectangle, autoconf.el
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28098
diff changeset
4821 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
2a26c31d59c5 replace-rectangle, autoconf.el
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28098
diff changeset
4822
28710
6efaa4627dee *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28699
diff changeset
4823 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
28855
1be9a502caca Cleaned some left over bogus conflict markers.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 28854
diff changeset
4824
30483
05fc373ff5b8 mention `float-time' and the remote file modtime check
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 30482
diff changeset
4825 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
28710
6efaa4627dee *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28699
diff changeset
4826 minibuffer with completion.
27714
22a581e00fe4 Mention some new packages, extra configure options.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27693
diff changeset
4827
28883
e43afc57ee04 todo-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28879
diff changeset
4828 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
e43afc57ee04 todo-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28879
diff changeset
4829 with the diary features.
e43afc57ee04 todo-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28879
diff changeset
4830
28912
717c04b51e93 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28883
diff changeset
4831 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
717c04b51e93 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28883
diff changeset
4832 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
717c04b51e93 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28883
diff changeset
4833
29814
daf26bf9d779 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29752
diff changeset
4834 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
daf26bf9d779 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29752
diff changeset
4835 Fill mode.
daf26bf9d779 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29752
diff changeset
4836
33020
e21feeab77fb See ChangeLog
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 33007
diff changeset
4837 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
e21feeab77fb See ChangeLog
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 33007
diff changeset
4838 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
e21feeab77fb See ChangeLog
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 33007
diff changeset
4839 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
e21feeab77fb See ChangeLog
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 33007
diff changeset
4840 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
32465
355b97042e28 non-ascii character ranges
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 32448
diff changeset
4841
38379
dd827746979d Mention antlr-mode.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38307
diff changeset
4842 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
dd827746979d Mention antlr-mode.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38307
diff changeset
4843 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
dd827746979d Mention antlr-mode.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38307
diff changeset
4844 `.g'.
dd827746979d Mention antlr-mode.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38307
diff changeset
4845
38900
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4846 ** Changes in sort.el
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4847
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4848 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4849 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4850 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4851 numeric base.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4852
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4853 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4854
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4855 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4856 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4857 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4858
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4859 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4860 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4861
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4862 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4863 output ^M at the end of lines.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4864
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4865 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4866 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4867
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4868 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4869 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4870 `(msb-mode 1)'.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4871
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4872 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4873 group.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4874
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4875 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4876 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4877 are recognized:
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4878
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4879 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4880 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4881 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4882 nil -- just delete one character.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4883
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4884 Default value is `untabify'.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4885
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4886 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4887
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4888 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4889 symbol, not double-quoted.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4890
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4891 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4892 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4893 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4894 moved to lisp/obsolete.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4895
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4896 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4897 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4898 `auto-compression-mode' command.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4899
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4900 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4901 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4902 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4903
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4904 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4905 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4906
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4907 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4908 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4909
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4910 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4911 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4912
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4913 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4914 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4915 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4916 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4917 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4918 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4919
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4920 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4921 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4922
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4923 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4924
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4925 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4926 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4927
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4928 ** Shell script mode changes.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4929
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4930 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4931 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4932 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4933
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4934 ** Etags changes.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4935
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4936 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4937
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4938 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4939 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4940 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4941 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4942 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4943
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4944 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4945 declarations when given the --declarations option.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4946
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4947 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4948 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4949
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4950 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4951 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4952 `template' keywords.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4953
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4954 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4955 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4956
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4957 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4958 types.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4959
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4960 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4961
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4962 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4963
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4964 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4965 are now tagged.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4966
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4967 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4968
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4969 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4970 variables are tagged.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4971
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4972 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4973
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4974 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4975 for PSWrap.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4976
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4977 ** Changes in etags.el
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4978
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4979 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4980 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4981 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4982
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4983 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4984 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4985
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4986 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4987 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4988 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4989 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4990
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4991 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4992
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4993 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4994 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4995
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4996 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4997
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4998 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
4999 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5000 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5001
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5002 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5003 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5004
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5005 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5006 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5007
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5008 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5009 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5010 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5011 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5012 point will go to the beginning of the file.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5013
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5014 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5015 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5016 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5017
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5018 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5019 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5020 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5021
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5022 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5023 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5024 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5025
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5026 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5027
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5028 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5029
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5030 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5031 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5032 expression from that list, are not checked.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5033
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5034 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5035 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5036 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5037 the buffer, just like for the local files.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5038
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5039 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5040
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5041 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5042 displays local abbrevs, only.
a3e94a8271e0 Reshuffle user-level changes to bring more important ones closer to the
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38894
diff changeset
5043
33290
b0b23815e8ca *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33274
diff changeset
5044 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
b0b23815e8ca *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33274
diff changeset
5045 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
b0b23815e8ca *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33274
diff changeset
5046
38605
f99d2e5ee830 Add description of double-click-fuzz.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38590
diff changeset
5047 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
f99d2e5ee830 Add description of double-click-fuzz.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38590
diff changeset
5048 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
f99d2e5ee830 Add description of double-click-fuzz.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38590
diff changeset
5049 is measured in pixels.
f99d2e5ee830 Add description of double-click-fuzz.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38590
diff changeset
5050
33290
b0b23815e8ca *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33274
diff changeset
5051 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
b0b23815e8ca *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33274
diff changeset
5052 to be visited as images.
b0b23815e8ca *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33274
diff changeset
5053
39270
daf37eb76fde grep-command and grep-find-command user options.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39255
diff changeset
5054 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
daf37eb76fde grep-command and grep-find-command user options.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39255
diff changeset
5055 were added to compile.el.
daf37eb76fde grep-command and grep-find-command user options.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39255
diff changeset
5056
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5057 ** Withdrawn packages
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5058
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5059 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5060 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
26133
5eb182b0c724 eval-reg removed.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26107
diff changeset
5061
27369
b7162d2b3d0b ph.el, user-init-file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27361
diff changeset
5062 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
b7162d2b3d0b ph.el, user-init-file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27361
diff changeset
5063
b7162d2b3d0b ph.el, user-init-file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27361
diff changeset
5064 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
29102
ba9cfbfc601e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28955
diff changeset
5065
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
5066
33991
b741aa7a2d46 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33990
diff changeset
5067 * Incompatible Lisp changes
b741aa7a2d46 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33990
diff changeset
5068
b741aa7a2d46 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33990
diff changeset
5069 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
b741aa7a2d46 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33990
diff changeset
5070 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
35421
adba111543f5 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35420
diff changeset
5071 See the sections below for details.
33991
b741aa7a2d46 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33990
diff changeset
5072
35297
e268b7b500f0 Changes for makefile support in etags.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 35278
diff changeset
5073 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
35847
83b8f5ad1f97 Several typos fixed. From Juanma Barranquero <lektu@uol.com.br>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35784
diff changeset
5074 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
41091
418fff19f92e Minor clarification.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 41055
diff changeset
5075 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
418fff19f92e Minor clarification.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 41055
diff changeset
5076 to remove the properties of the copy.
33991
b741aa7a2d46 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33990
diff changeset
5077
b741aa7a2d46 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33990
diff changeset
5078 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
b741aa7a2d46 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33990
diff changeset
5079 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
b741aa7a2d46 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33990
diff changeset
5080 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
b741aa7a2d46 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33990
diff changeset
5081 these properties are active.
b741aa7a2d46 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33990
diff changeset
5082
34029
d80bd382fa99 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 34017
diff changeset
5083 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
33991
b741aa7a2d46 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33990
diff changeset
5084 ranges may affect some code.
34017
8cf5499796cc *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 34001
diff changeset
5085
8cf5499796cc *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 34001
diff changeset
5086 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
8cf5499796cc *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 34001
diff changeset
5087 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
8cf5499796cc *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 34001
diff changeset
5088 make a difference to some code.
8cf5499796cc *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 34001
diff changeset
5089
34029
d80bd382fa99 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 34017
diff changeset
5090 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
d80bd382fa99 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 34017
diff changeset
5091 operates on the minibuffer.
d80bd382fa99 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 34017
diff changeset
5092
34087
4fcc3c4e9b0f Explain why `no-conversion' is no longer appropriate for reading
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34060
diff changeset
5093 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
4fcc3c4e9b0f Explain why `no-conversion' is no longer appropriate for reading
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34060
diff changeset
5094 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
4fcc3c4e9b0f Explain why `no-conversion' is no longer appropriate for reading
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34060
diff changeset
5095 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
4fcc3c4e9b0f Explain why `no-conversion' is no longer appropriate for reading
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34060
diff changeset
5096 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
4fcc3c4e9b0f Explain why `no-conversion' is no longer appropriate for reading
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34060
diff changeset
5097 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
4fcc3c4e9b0f Explain why `no-conversion' is no longer appropriate for reading
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34060
diff changeset
5098 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
4fcc3c4e9b0f Explain why `no-conversion' is no longer appropriate for reading
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34060
diff changeset
5099 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
4fcc3c4e9b0f Explain why `no-conversion' is no longer appropriate for reading
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34060
diff changeset
5100 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
4fcc3c4e9b0f Explain why `no-conversion' is no longer appropriate for reading
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34060
diff changeset
5101 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
4fcc3c4e9b0f Explain why `no-conversion' is no longer appropriate for reading
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34060
diff changeset
5102 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
4fcc3c4e9b0f Explain why `no-conversion' is no longer appropriate for reading
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34060
diff changeset
5103 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
4fcc3c4e9b0f Explain why `no-conversion' is no longer appropriate for reading
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34060
diff changeset
5104 the buffer as multibyte characters.
4fcc3c4e9b0f Explain why `no-conversion' is no longer appropriate for reading
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34060
diff changeset
5105
4fcc3c4e9b0f Explain why `no-conversion' is no longer appropriate for reading
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34060
diff changeset
5106 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
4fcc3c4e9b0f Explain why `no-conversion' is no longer appropriate for reading
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34060
diff changeset
5107 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
4fcc3c4e9b0f Explain why `no-conversion' is no longer appropriate for reading
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34060
diff changeset
5108 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
4fcc3c4e9b0f Explain why `no-conversion' is no longer appropriate for reading
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34060
diff changeset
5109
34617
1759a3374578 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 34564
diff changeset
5110 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
35242
910222f6a03c Tell them to use before-change-functions and after-change-functions
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35223
diff changeset
5111 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
910222f6a03c Tell them to use before-change-functions and after-change-functions
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35223
diff changeset
5112 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
34617
1759a3374578 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 34564
diff changeset
5113
1759a3374578 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 34564
diff changeset
5114 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
44087
c8f919cc34e2 Clarify that mapconcat will also throw an error when it invokes
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44072
diff changeset
5115 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
c8f919cc34e2 Clarify that mapconcat will also throw an error when it invokes
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 44072
diff changeset
5116 such as `mapconcat'.
34617
1759a3374578 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 34564
diff changeset
5117
38649
021a0445b5f6 Mention the change in base64-decode-string whereby the result is
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
5118 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
021a0445b5f6 Mention the change in base64-decode-string whereby the result is
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
5119 string.
021a0445b5f6 Mention the change in base64-decode-string whereby the result is
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
5120
36244
7f8002783bf3 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36113
diff changeset
5121 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
7f8002783bf3 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36113
diff changeset
5122 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
7f8002783bf3 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36113
diff changeset
5123 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
7f8002783bf3 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36113
diff changeset
5124 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
7f8002783bf3 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36113
diff changeset
5125 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
7f8002783bf3 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36113
diff changeset
5126 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
36470
67c8e0a89b2d *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36428
diff changeset
5127 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
67c8e0a89b2d *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36428
diff changeset
5128 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
36113
1a29f6d22f6e Mention potential incompatibilities due to new dimension-2 charsets.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36039
diff changeset
5129
37077
8b914cd4ae0c Fix the wording about directory-sep-char deprecation.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37064
diff changeset
5130 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
8b914cd4ae0c Fix the wording about directory-sep-char deprecation.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37064
diff changeset
5131 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
8b914cd4ae0c Fix the wording about directory-sep-char deprecation.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37064
diff changeset
5132 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
8b914cd4ae0c Fix the wording about directory-sep-char deprecation.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37064
diff changeset
5133 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
8b914cd4ae0c Fix the wording about directory-sep-char deprecation.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37064
diff changeset
5134 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
8b914cd4ae0c Fix the wording about directory-sep-char deprecation.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37064
diff changeset
5135 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
8b914cd4ae0c Fix the wording about directory-sep-char deprecation.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37064
diff changeset
5136 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
8b914cd4ae0c Fix the wording about directory-sep-char deprecation.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37064
diff changeset
5137 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
8b914cd4ae0c Fix the wording about directory-sep-char deprecation.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37064
diff changeset
5138 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
8b914cd4ae0c Fix the wording about directory-sep-char deprecation.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37064
diff changeset
5139 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
37064
428092eb22d4 Document that directory-sep-char is deprecated.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37061
diff changeset
5140
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
5141
29102
ba9cfbfc601e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28955
diff changeset
5142 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
ba9cfbfc601e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28955
diff changeset
5143 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
ba9cfbfc601e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28955
diff changeset
5144
39089
64e39b9789cc *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39075
diff changeset
5145 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
64e39b9789cc *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39075
diff changeset
5146
41356
39332ec6c47d Fix typos.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 41355
diff changeset
5147 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
38527
71c6489a2aff *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38471
diff changeset
5148 allows the animated display of strings.
71c6489a2aff *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38471
diff changeset
5149
37061
e5b70de7b794 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37009
diff changeset
5150 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
e5b70de7b794 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37009
diff changeset
5151 interactive form of a function.
e5b70de7b794 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37009
diff changeset
5152
36885
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
5153 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
5154 between custom options. Example:
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
5155
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
5156 (defcustom default-input-method nil
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
5157 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
5158 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
5159 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
5160 :group 'mule
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
5161 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
5162 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
5163
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
5164 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
5165 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
5166 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
5167
35862
9604ca6b3728 More typos from Juanma Barranquero <lektu@uol.com.br>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35847
diff changeset
5168 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
35125
95799f3353e7 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35090
diff changeset
5169 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
95799f3353e7 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35090
diff changeset
5170 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
95799f3353e7 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35090
diff changeset
5171 (signal or normal termination).
95799f3353e7 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35090
diff changeset
5172
35090
b876bd6bde9e butlast, nbutlast.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35064
diff changeset
5173 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
b876bd6bde9e butlast, nbutlast.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35064
diff changeset
5174 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
b876bd6bde9e butlast, nbutlast.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35064
diff changeset
5175
34271
52c06c998aac *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 34204
diff changeset
5176 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
52c06c998aac *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 34204
diff changeset
5177 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
52c06c998aac *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 34204
diff changeset
5178
33373
701833d4b661 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33364
diff changeset
5179 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
701833d4b661 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33364
diff changeset
5180 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
701833d4b661 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33364
diff changeset
5181
34054
da7a782777bc *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 34029
diff changeset
5182 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
33364
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33315
diff changeset
5183
32913
8a79f057b2a5 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 32865
diff changeset
5184 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
8a79f057b2a5 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 32865
diff changeset
5185 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
8a79f057b2a5 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 32865
diff changeset
5186 being deleted.
8a79f057b2a5 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 32865
diff changeset
5187
32845
e92097fd9144 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 32751
diff changeset
5188 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
e92097fd9144 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 32751
diff changeset
5189
32466
90886fd49673 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 32465
diff changeset
5190 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
32465
355b97042e28 non-ascii character ranges
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 32448
diff changeset
5191 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
355b97042e28 non-ascii character ranges
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 32448
diff changeset
5192 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
355b97042e28 non-ascii character ranges
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 32448
diff changeset
5193 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
355b97042e28 non-ascii character ranges
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 32448
diff changeset
5194 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
355b97042e28 non-ascii character ranges
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 32448
diff changeset
5195 charset.
355b97042e28 non-ascii character ranges
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 32448
diff changeset
5196
32259
cae38860a9ee Add entry for `display-message-or-buffer'.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32257
diff changeset
5197 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
cae38860a9ee Add entry for `display-message-or-buffer'.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32257
diff changeset
5198 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
cae38860a9ee Add entry for `display-message-or-buffer'.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32257
diff changeset
5199 message.
cae38860a9ee Add entry for `display-message-or-buffer'.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32257
diff changeset
5200
32050
2a3bcf8d9877 Add entries for `auto-image-file-mode' and `with-auto-compression-mode'.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32037
diff changeset
5201 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
2a3bcf8d9877 Add entries for `auto-image-file-mode' and `with-auto-compression-mode'.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32037
diff changeset
5202 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
2a3bcf8d9877 Add entries for `auto-image-file-mode' and `with-auto-compression-mode'.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32037
diff changeset
5203
31636
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
5204 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
5205 with the more general `:mask' property.
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
5206
35364
19c93f3ebdce *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35326
diff changeset
5207 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
31728
1b791fcfaa10 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31641
diff changeset
5208
31561
b441ceb31859 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31388
diff changeset
5209 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
b441ceb31859 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31388
diff changeset
5210 backslash.
b441ceb31859 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31388
diff changeset
5211
31007
0e3404fe9965 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31004
diff changeset
5212 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
0e3404fe9965 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31004
diff changeset
5213 is running in batch mode. For example,
0e3404fe9965 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31004
diff changeset
5214
0e3404fe9965 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31004
diff changeset
5215 (message "%s" (read t))
0e3404fe9965 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31004
diff changeset
5216
0e3404fe9965 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31004
diff changeset
5217 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
0e3404fe9965 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31004
diff changeset
5218 to standard output.
0e3404fe9965 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31004
diff changeset
5219
0e3404fe9965 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31004
diff changeset
5220 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
0e3404fe9965 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31004
diff changeset
5221 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
0e3404fe9965 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31004
diff changeset
5222
30564
a363ab77020c *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30518
diff changeset
5223 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
a363ab77020c *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30518
diff changeset
5224 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
a363ab77020c *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30518
diff changeset
5225 frame or window.
a363ab77020c *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30518
diff changeset
5226
30516
148c11ee6b89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30511
diff changeset
5227 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
148c11ee6b89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30511
diff changeset
5228 were added
148c11ee6b89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30511
diff changeset
5229
148c11ee6b89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30511
diff changeset
5230 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
148c11ee6b89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30511
diff changeset
5231
35680
1a6073992224 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35665
diff changeset
5232 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
30516
148c11ee6b89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30511
diff changeset
5233 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
148c11ee6b89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30511
diff changeset
5234
148c11ee6b89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30511
diff changeset
5235 - Function: remq ELT LIST
148c11ee6b89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30511
diff changeset
5236
35680
1a6073992224 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35665
diff changeset
5237 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
30516
148c11ee6b89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30511
diff changeset
5238 comparison is done with `eq'.
148c11ee6b89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30511
diff changeset
5239
148c11ee6b89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30511
diff changeset
5240 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
30511
2ac427297d38 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30502
diff changeset
5241
30502
0dca3aa6405a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30483
diff changeset
5242 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
39075
8722aa0ae475 Mark (almost) all entries either --- or +++.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39031
diff changeset
5243 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
39441
cecec2db4346 Fix typo.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39300
diff changeset
5244 `key-and-value', in addition the `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
30502
0dca3aa6405a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30483
diff changeset
5245
30357
2696b797cd2f *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 30339
diff changeset
5246 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
2696b797cd2f *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 30339
diff changeset
5247 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
2696b797cd2f *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 30339
diff changeset
5248 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
2696b797cd2f *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 30339
diff changeset
5249
30219
87d8ca1f4b52 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30206
diff changeset
5250 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
87d8ca1f4b52 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30206
diff changeset
5251 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
30203
34881d6fc1f6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30158
diff changeset
5252
30158
84d54b049d67 make-obsolete, plist-member changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 30155
diff changeset
5253 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
84d54b049d67 make-obsolete, plist-member changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 30155
diff changeset
5254 function was declared obsolete.
84d54b049d67 make-obsolete, plist-member changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 30155
diff changeset
5255
30483
05fc373ff5b8 mention `float-time' and the remote file modtime check
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 30482
diff changeset
5256 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
30158
84d54b049d67 make-obsolete, plist-member changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 30155
diff changeset
5257 retained as an alias).
84d54b049d67 make-obsolete, plist-member changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 30155
diff changeset
5258
30068
fd80ab818a0c Fix various typos.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 30056
diff changeset
5259 ** Easy-menu's :filter now works as in XEmacs.
fd80ab818a0c Fix various typos.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 30056
diff changeset
5260 It takes the unconverted (i.e. XEmacs) form of the menu and the result
fd80ab818a0c Fix various typos.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 30056
diff changeset
5261 is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
fd80ab818a0c Fix various typos.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 30056
diff changeset
5262
30038
9a141c819d48 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30012
diff changeset
5263 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
9a141c819d48 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30012
diff changeset
5264
33620
62859e71806e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33618
diff changeset
5265 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
62859e71806e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33618
diff changeset
5266
62859e71806e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33618
diff changeset
5267 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
62859e71806e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33618
diff changeset
5268 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
62859e71806e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33618
diff changeset
5269 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
62859e71806e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33618
diff changeset
5270 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
62859e71806e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33618
diff changeset
5271 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
62859e71806e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33618
diff changeset
5272 means never include the minibuffer window.
30038
9a141c819d48 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30012
diff changeset
5273
39179
d0b29a3ee609 some-window -> get-window-with-predicate.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39089
diff changeset
5274 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
d0b29a3ee609 some-window -> get-window-with-predicate.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39089
diff changeset
5275
d0b29a3ee609 some-window -> get-window-with-predicate.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39089
diff changeset
5276 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
30006
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5277
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5278 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5279
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5280 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5281 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5282 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5283 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5284 returned.
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5285
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5286 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5287 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5288 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5289 minibuffer even if it is active.
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5290
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5291 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5292 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5293 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5294 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5295 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5296 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5297
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5298 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5299 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5300 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5301 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5302 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5303 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5304 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
f39010aa1be6 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29972
diff changeset
5305
30564
a363ab77020c *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30518
diff changeset
5306 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
a363ab77020c *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30518
diff changeset
5307 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
a363ab77020c *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30518
diff changeset
5308 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
29657
cdef08609770 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29637
diff changeset
5309
29637
6b63e5410a0e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29633
diff changeset
5310 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
6b63e5410a0e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29633
diff changeset
5311 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
30290
5d592031fd61 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30278
diff changeset
5312 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
5d592031fd61 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30278
diff changeset
5313 Default value is nil.
29637
6b63e5410a0e *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29633
diff changeset
5314
30483
05fc373ff5b8 mention `float-time' and the remote file modtime check
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 30482
diff changeset
5315 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
29633
98e1c27ffe84 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29533
diff changeset
5316 meaning no limit.
98e1c27ffe84 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29533
diff changeset
5317
38126
64a45ba0553f Document line-number-display-limit-width.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38107
diff changeset
5318 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
64a45ba0553f Document line-number-display-limit-width.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38107
diff changeset
5319 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
64a45ba0553f Document line-number-display-limit-width.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38107
diff changeset
5320 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
64a45ba0553f Document line-number-display-limit-width.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38107
diff changeset
5321
30483
05fc373ff5b8 mention `float-time' and the remote file modtime check
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 30482
diff changeset
5322 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
29509
fc84e59f692c Preferred coding system change.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29506
diff changeset
5323 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
fc84e59f692c Preferred coding system change.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29506
diff changeset
5324 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
fc84e59f692c Preferred coding system change.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29506
diff changeset
5325
34001
fc9ba8a24dde *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33991
diff changeset
5326 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
fc9ba8a24dde *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33991
diff changeset
5327 list of a primitive.
29238
552f0327e586 subr-arity
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29218
diff changeset
5328
33111
bbf383648e4d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 33020
diff changeset
5329 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
bbf383648e4d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 33020
diff changeset
5330
29286
c0fe782084bb keymap property.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29238
diff changeset
5331 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
c0fe782084bb keymap property.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29238
diff changeset
5332 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
c0fe782084bb keymap property.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29238
diff changeset
5333 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
c0fe782084bb keymap property.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29238
diff changeset
5334 than replacing the local map.
c0fe782084bb keymap property.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29238
diff changeset
5335
35250
d6a8befb918c *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35242
diff changeset
5336 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
d6a8befb918c *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35242
diff changeset
5337 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
d6a8befb918c *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35242
diff changeset
5338 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
d6a8befb918c *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35242
diff changeset
5339 instead.
29498
4b79925ce8fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29381
diff changeset
5340
4b79925ce8fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29381
diff changeset
5341 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
4b79925ce8fa *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29381
diff changeset
5342
33111
bbf383648e4d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 33020
diff changeset
5343 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
bbf383648e4d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 33020
diff changeset
5344 as promised long ago.
30339
70d759570f7a C-down-mouse-3. Move concat change.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 30319
diff changeset
5345
30483
05fc373ff5b8 mention `float-time' and the remote file modtime check
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 30482
diff changeset
5346 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
37749
1d5371e8a974 Add entry for auto-coding-regexp-alist.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37446
diff changeset
5347
1d5371e8a974 Add entry for auto-coding-regexp-alist.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37446
diff changeset
5348 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
1d5371e8a974 Add entry for auto-coding-regexp-alist.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37446
diff changeset
5349 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
1d5371e8a974 Add entry for auto-coding-regexp-alist.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37446
diff changeset
5350 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
1d5371e8a974 Add entry for auto-coding-regexp-alist.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37446
diff changeset
5351
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
5352
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5353 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5354
39517
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5355 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5356 regular expressions.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5357
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5358 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5359
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5360 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5361
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5362 - Macro: rx SEXP
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5363
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5364 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5365
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5366 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5367 notation.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5368
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5369 STRING
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5370 matches string STRING literally.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5371
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5372 CHAR
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5373 matches character CHAR literally.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5374
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5375 `not-newline'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5376 matches any character except a newline.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5377 .
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5378 `anything'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5379 matches any character
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5380
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5381 `(any SET)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5382 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5383 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5384
40215
77247104a65e mention html-xhtml
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 40190
diff changeset
5385 '(in SET)'
39517
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5386 like `any'.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5387
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5388 `(not (any SET))'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5389 matches any character not in SET
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5390
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5391 `line-start'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5392 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5393 in the text being matched
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5394
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5395 `line-end'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5396 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5397
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5398 `string-start'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5399 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5400 string being matched against.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5401
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5402 `string-end'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5403 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5404 string being matched against.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5405
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5406 `buffer-start'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5407 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5408 buffer being matched against.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5409
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5410 `buffer-end'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5411 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5412 buffer being matched against.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5413
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5414 `point'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5415 matches the empty string, but only at point.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5416
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5417 `word-start'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5418 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5419 word.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5420
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5421 `word-end'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5422 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5423
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5424 `word-boundary'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5425 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5426 word.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5427
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5428 `(not word-boundary)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5429 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5430 word.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5431
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5432 `digit'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5433 matches 0 through 9.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5434
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5435 `control'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5436 matches ASCII control characters.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5437
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5438 `hex-digit'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5439 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5440
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5441 `blank'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5442 matches space and tab only.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5443
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5444 `graphic'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5445 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5446 space, and DEL.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5447
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5448 `printing'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5449 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5450 and DEL.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5451
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5452 `alphanumeric'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5453 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5454 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5455
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5456 `letter'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5457 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5458 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5459
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5460 `ascii'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5461 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5462
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5463 `nonascii'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5464 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5465
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5466 `lower'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5467 matches anything lower-case.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5468
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5469 `upper'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5470 matches anything upper-case.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5471
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5472 `punctuation'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5473 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5474 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5475
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5476 `space'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5477 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5478
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5479 `word'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5480 matches anything that has word syntax.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5481
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5482 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5483 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5484 of the following symbols.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5485
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5486 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5487 `punctuation' (\\s.)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5488 `word' (\\sw)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5489 `symbol' (\\s_)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5490 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5491 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5492 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5493 `string-quote' (\\s\")
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5494 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5495 `escape' (\\s\\)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5496 `character-quote' (\\s/)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5497 `comment-start' (\\s<)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5498 `comment-end' (\\s>)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5499
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5500 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5501 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5502
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5503 `(category CATEGORY)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5504 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5505 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5506
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5507 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5508 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5509 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5510 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5511 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5512 `symbol' (\\c5)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5513 `digit' (\\c6)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5514 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5515 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5516 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5517 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5518 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5519 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5520 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5521 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5522 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
49407
c47a7a3493da *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49395
diff changeset
5523 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
39517
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5524 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5525 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5526 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5527 `ascii' (\\ca)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5528 `arabic' (\\cb)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5529 `chinese' (\\cc)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5530 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5531 `greek' (\\cg)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5532 `korean' (\\ch)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5533 `indian' (\\ci)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5534 `japanese' (\\cj)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5535 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5536 `latin' (\\cl)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5537 `lao' (\\co)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5538 `tibetan' (\\cq)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5539 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5540 `thai' (\\ct)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5541 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5542 `hebrew' (\\cw)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5543 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5544 `can-break' (\\c|)
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5545
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5546 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5547 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5548
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5549 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5550 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5551
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5552 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5553 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5554 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5555
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5556 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5557 another name for `submatch'.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5558
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5559 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5560 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5561 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5562 regular expression.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5563
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5564 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5565 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
45901
1b38863a543b *** empty log message ***
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 45891
diff changeset
5566 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
39517
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5567 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5568 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5569
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5570 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
47283
0f65e6f1d100 Fix spacing.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 47201
diff changeset
5571 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
39517
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5572
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5573 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5574 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5575
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5576 `(0+ SEXP)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5577 like `zero-or-more'.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5578
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5579 `(* SEXP)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5580 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5581
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5582 `(*? SEXP)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5583 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5584
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5585 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5586 matches one or more occurrences of A.
40215
77247104a65e mention html-xhtml
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 40190
diff changeset
5587
39517
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5588 `(1+ SEXP)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5589 like `one-or-more'.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5590
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5591 `(+ SEXP)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5592 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5593
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5594 `(+? SEXP)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5595 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5596
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5597 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5598 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
40215
77247104a65e mention html-xhtml
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 40190
diff changeset
5599
39517
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5600 `(optional SEXP)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5601 like `zero-or-one'.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5602
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5603 `(? SEXP)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5604 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5605
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5606 `(?? SEXP)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5607 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5608
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5609 `(repeat N SEXP)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5610 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5611
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5612 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5613 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5614
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5615 `(eval FORM)'
47283
0f65e6f1d100 Fix spacing.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 47201
diff changeset
5616 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
39517
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5617 `regexp-quote' it.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5618
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5619 `(regexp REGEXP)'
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5620 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
81ce748b1748 Mention Rx.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 39485
diff changeset
5621
36811
a37eeb9f04f3 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36798
diff changeset
5622 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
a37eeb9f04f3 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 36798
diff changeset
5623
30933
3a89352a7dab Document save-restriction fix.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30930
diff changeset
5624 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
3a89352a7dab Document save-restriction fix.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30930
diff changeset
5625 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
3a89352a7dab Document save-restriction fix.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30930
diff changeset
5626 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
3a89352a7dab Document save-restriction fix.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30930
diff changeset
5627 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
3a89352a7dab Document save-restriction fix.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30930
diff changeset
5628
29506
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5629 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5630 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
36470
67c8e0a89b2d *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36428
diff changeset
5631 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
29506
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5632 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5633
39255
2ccde3c50b3a Fix a typo.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39232
diff changeset
5634 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
39212
34e0c37a5809 string-as-{muti,uni}byte doesn't act on a buffer.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39179
diff changeset
5635 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
34e0c37a5809 string-as-{muti,uni}byte doesn't act on a buffer.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39179
diff changeset
5636 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
29506
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5637
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5638 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5639 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5640 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5641 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5642 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5643 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5644 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5645 eight-bit-graphic.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5646
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5647 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5648
35847
83b8f5ad1f97 Several typos fixed. From Juanma Barranquero <lektu@uol.com.br>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35784
diff changeset
5649 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
29506
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5650 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5651 character set as previously.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5652
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5653 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5654 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5655 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5656
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5657 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5658 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5659 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5660 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5661
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5662 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
35847
83b8f5ad1f97 Several typos fixed. From Juanma Barranquero <lektu@uol.com.br>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35784
diff changeset
5663 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
29506
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5664
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5665 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5666 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5667 "fontset-default".
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5668
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5669 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5670 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5671
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5672 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5673 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5674 buffers and strings.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5675
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5676 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5677 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5678 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5679 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5680 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5681 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5682 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5683 also been deleted.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5684
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5685 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5686 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5687 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5688
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5689 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5690 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5691 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5692 may differ between buffer and string text.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5693
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5694 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5695 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5696
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5697 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5698 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5699 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5700 `composition' from STRING.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5701
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5702 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5703 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5704
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5705 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5706 obsolete.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5707
36039
9c2bd5a836b3 point to INSTALL
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35937
diff changeset
5708 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
9c2bd5a836b3 point to INSTALL
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35937
diff changeset
5709 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
9c2bd5a836b3 point to INSTALL
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35937
diff changeset
5710
33290
b0b23815e8ca *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33274
diff changeset
5711 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
35937
f6e7e24f14e9 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35927
diff changeset
5712 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
f6e7e24f14e9 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35927
diff changeset
5713 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
f6e7e24f14e9 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35927
diff changeset
5714 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
f6e7e24f14e9 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35927
diff changeset
5715
38012
3bf93c45de95 Mention that mule-unicode-* charsets aren't unified with the others.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37948
diff changeset
5716 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
3bf93c45de95 Mention that mule-unicode-* charsets aren't unified with the others.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37948
diff changeset
5717 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
3bf93c45de95 Mention that mule-unicode-* charsets aren't unified with the others.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37948
diff changeset
5718 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
3bf93c45de95 Mention that mule-unicode-* charsets aren't unified with the others.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37948
diff changeset
5719 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
3bf93c45de95 Mention that mule-unicode-* charsets aren't unified with the others.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37948
diff changeset
5720 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
3bf93c45de95 Mention that mule-unicode-* charsets aren't unified with the others.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37948
diff changeset
5721 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
3bf93c45de95 Mention that mule-unicode-* charsets aren't unified with the others.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37948
diff changeset
5722
3bf93c45de95 Mention that mule-unicode-* charsets aren't unified with the others.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37948
diff changeset
5723 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
3bf93c45de95 Mention that mule-unicode-* charsets aren't unified with the others.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37948
diff changeset
5724 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
3bf93c45de95 Mention that mule-unicode-* charsets aren't unified with the others.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37948
diff changeset
5725 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
35557
eb649a1c81eb *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 35470
diff changeset
5726
29506
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5727 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
35937
f6e7e24f14e9 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35927
diff changeset
5728 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
f6e7e24f14e9 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35927
diff changeset
5729 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
f6e7e24f14e9 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35927
diff changeset
5730
f6e7e24f14e9 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35927
diff changeset
5731 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
f6e7e24f14e9 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35927
diff changeset
5732 have been introduced.
29506
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5733
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5734 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
35937
f6e7e24f14e9 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35927
diff changeset
5735 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
36470
67c8e0a89b2d *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36428
diff changeset
5736 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
67c8e0a89b2d *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36428
diff changeset
5737 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
67c8e0a89b2d *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36428
diff changeset
5738 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
36885
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
5739 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
5740 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
5741 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
5742 their multibyte equivalent.
29506
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
5743
28847
c27ead6e7ea1 write-region change
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28834
diff changeset
5744 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
c27ead6e7ea1 write-region change
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28834
diff changeset
5745 that offset in the file before writing.
c27ead6e7ea1 write-region change
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28834
diff changeset
5746
30068
fd80ab818a0c Fix various typos.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 30056
diff changeset
5747 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
fd80ab818a0c Fix various typos.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 30056
diff changeset
5748 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
28724
48df558593f9 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28710
diff changeset
5749
28710
6efaa4627dee *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28699
diff changeset
5750 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
6efaa4627dee *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28699
diff changeset
5751 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
6efaa4627dee *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28699
diff changeset
5752 from which the command was issued.
6efaa4627dee *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28699
diff changeset
5753
6efaa4627dee *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28699
diff changeset
5754 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
6efaa4627dee *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28699
diff changeset
5755 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
6efaa4627dee *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28699
diff changeset
5756 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
6efaa4627dee *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28699
diff changeset
5757 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
6efaa4627dee *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28699
diff changeset
5758 operate on.
6efaa4627dee *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28699
diff changeset
5759
28658
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5760 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5761 to `window-buffer-height'.
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5762
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5763 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5764
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5765 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5766 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5767 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5768
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5769 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5770 respectively.
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5771
35680
1a6073992224 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35665
diff changeset
5772 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
28658
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5773 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5774
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5775 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5776 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5777 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5778
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5779 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5780 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5781 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5782 is currently displayed in some window.
bb5083cf0565 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28634
diff changeset
5783
28556
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28525
diff changeset
5784 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28525
diff changeset
5785 argument function's results.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28525
diff changeset
5786
28496
92a9591b21a2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28492
diff changeset
5787 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
38649
021a0445b5f6 Mention the change in base64-decode-string whereby the result is
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
5788 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
39075
8722aa0ae475 Mark (almost) all entries either --- or +++.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39031
diff changeset
5789 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
8722aa0ae475 Mark (almost) all entries either --- or +++.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 39031
diff changeset
5790 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
38649
021a0445b5f6 Mention the change in base64-decode-string whereby the result is
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
5791 sequence).
28496
92a9591b21a2 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28492
diff changeset
5792
28492
fc5e9fc89c9d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28396
diff changeset
5793 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
31859
9bb38b47a241 Fix typo.
Thien-Thi Nguyen <ttn@gnuvola.org>
parents: 31858
diff changeset
5794 header in the list of headers passed to it.
28492
fc5e9fc89c9d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28396
diff changeset
5795
fc5e9fc89c9d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28396
diff changeset
5796 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
fc5e9fc89c9d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28396
diff changeset
5797 ignores differences in case and text representation.
fc5e9fc89c9d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28396
diff changeset
5798
fc5e9fc89c9d *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28396
diff changeset
5799 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
28323
c58dc3f08133 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28303
diff changeset
5800 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
c58dc3f08133 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28303
diff changeset
5801 as follows:
c58dc3f08133 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28303
diff changeset
5802
c58dc3f08133 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28303
diff changeset
5803 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
c58dc3f08133 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28303
diff changeset
5804 nil don't display a cursor
c58dc3f08133 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28303
diff changeset
5805 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
c58dc3f08133 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28303
diff changeset
5806 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
c58dc3f08133 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28303
diff changeset
5807 others display a box cursor.
c58dc3f08133 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28303
diff changeset
5808
28303
8bdd3f67b91a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28292
diff changeset
5809 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
8bdd3f67b91a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28292
diff changeset
5810 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
8bdd3f67b91a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28292
diff changeset
5811 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
8bdd3f67b91a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28292
diff changeset
5812 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
8bdd3f67b91a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28292
diff changeset
5813
28194
59c09e95d278 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28166
diff changeset
5814 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
28854
a5c81109bc31 Mention PCL-CVS.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 28847
diff changeset
5815 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
28194
59c09e95d278 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28166
diff changeset
5816 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
59c09e95d278 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28166
diff changeset
5817 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
59c09e95d278 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28166
diff changeset
5818
59c09e95d278 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28166
diff changeset
5819 Example:
59c09e95d278 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28166
diff changeset
5820
59c09e95d278 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28166
diff changeset
5821 (string-to-syntax "()")
59c09e95d278 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28166
diff changeset
5822 => (4 . 41)
59c09e95d278 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28166
diff changeset
5823
28166
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5824 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5825 other than 10.
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5826
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5827 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5828 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5829
30483
05fc373ff5b8 mention `float-time' and the remote file modtime check
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 30482
diff changeset
5830 #b1111
28166
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5831 => 15
30483
05fc373ff5b8 mention `float-time' and the remote file modtime check
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 30482
diff changeset
5832 #b-1111
28166
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5833 => -15
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5834
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5835 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5836
30483
05fc373ff5b8 mention `float-time' and the remote file modtime check
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 30482
diff changeset
5837 #o666
28166
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5838 => 438
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5839
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5840 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5841
30483
05fc373ff5b8 mention `float-time' and the remote file modtime check
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 30482
diff changeset
5842 #xbeef
28166
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5843 => 48815
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5844
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5845 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5846
30483
05fc373ff5b8 mention `float-time' and the remote file modtime check
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 30482
diff changeset
5847 #2R-111
28166
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5848 => -7
30483
05fc373ff5b8 mention `float-time' and the remote file modtime check
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 30482
diff changeset
5849 #25rah
28166
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5850 => 267
f3ea89b2cc47 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28159
diff changeset
5851
28335
012be509f4f4 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28323
diff changeset
5852 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
30068
fd80ab818a0c Fix various typos.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 30056
diff changeset
5853 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
28037
acbd35afbe7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27995
diff changeset
5854 and isn't a string.
acbd35afbe7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27995
diff changeset
5855
28335
012be509f4f4 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28323
diff changeset
5856 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
012be509f4f4 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28323
diff changeset
5857 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
012be509f4f4 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28323
diff changeset
5858 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
012be509f4f4 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28323
diff changeset
5859 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
012be509f4f4 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28323
diff changeset
5860
27881
f54471f7b913 replace-regexps-in-string, mouse-position-function, define-key-after change
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27847
diff changeset
5861 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
f54471f7b913 replace-regexps-in-string, mouse-position-function, define-key-after change
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27847
diff changeset
5862
28149
fd72698178e7 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28140
diff changeset
5863 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
27881
f54471f7b913 replace-regexps-in-string, mouse-position-function, define-key-after change
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27847
diff changeset
5864 for a regexp in a string.
f54471f7b913 replace-regexps-in-string, mouse-position-function, define-key-after change
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27847
diff changeset
5865
f54471f7b913 replace-regexps-in-string, mouse-position-function, define-key-after change
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27847
diff changeset
5866 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
f54471f7b913 replace-regexps-in-string, mouse-position-function, define-key-after change
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27847
diff changeset
5867 `mouse-position-function'.
f54471f7b913 replace-regexps-in-string, mouse-position-function, define-key-after change
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27847
diff changeset
5868
27827
25e4e0c9c19a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27820
diff changeset
5869 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
25e4e0c9c19a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27820
diff changeset
5870 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
25e4e0c9c19a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27820
diff changeset
5871
27820
2d9b98395c82 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27770
diff changeset
5872 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
2d9b98395c82 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27770
diff changeset
5873 Keywords are now always considered constants.
2d9b98395c82 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27770
diff changeset
5874
27770
38f6e392c0aa *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27733
diff changeset
5875 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
38f6e392c0aa *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27733
diff changeset
5876 returns it.
38f6e392c0aa *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27733
diff changeset
5877
27276
61772f3ab92f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27266
diff changeset
5878 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
61772f3ab92f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27266
diff changeset
5879 returned by function `recent-keys'.
61772f3ab92f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27266
diff changeset
5880
27385
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5881 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5882 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
40526
b466f4f946a7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40493
diff changeset
5883 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
27385
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5884 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5885 mode.
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5886
27094
6500fd0a7d8e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 27092
diff changeset
5887 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
6500fd0a7d8e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 27092
diff changeset
5888 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
6500fd0a7d8e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 27092
diff changeset
5889
27385
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5890 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5891 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5892 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5893 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5894 been performed."
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5895
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5896 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5897 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5898 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5899 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5900
26737
0aad3e0b47d2 Change of intern-soft.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26728
diff changeset
5901 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
0aad3e0b47d2 Change of intern-soft.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26728
diff changeset
5902 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
0aad3e0b47d2 Change of intern-soft.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26728
diff changeset
5903 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
0aad3e0b47d2 Change of intern-soft.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26728
diff changeset
5904
26467
fe1632dc5fb3 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26432
diff changeset
5905 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
fe1632dc5fb3 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26432
diff changeset
5906 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
fe1632dc5fb3 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26432
diff changeset
5907 specified table.
fe1632dc5fb3 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26432
diff changeset
5908
fe1632dc5fb3 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26432
diff changeset
5909 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
fe1632dc5fb3 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26432
diff changeset
5910
fe1632dc5fb3 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26432
diff changeset
5911 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
26541
ce6bf7b42bc7 --with-syntax-table changed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26525
diff changeset
5912 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
ce6bf7b42bc7 --with-syntax-table changed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26525
diff changeset
5913 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
ce6bf7b42bc7 --with-syntax-table changed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26525
diff changeset
5914 what BODY returns.
26467
fe1632dc5fb3 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26432
diff changeset
5915
27693
d8bedafef8d5 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 27644
diff changeset
5916 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
28063
f1b33463506d *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 28051
diff changeset
5917 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
35680
1a6073992224 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35665
diff changeset
5918 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
33913
0c780fd30da5 New font-lock-doc-face.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 33862
diff changeset
5919 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
0c780fd30da5 New font-lock-doc-face.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 33862
diff changeset
5920 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
27094
6500fd0a7d8e *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 27092
diff changeset
5921
26397
17d6fe2e2d0f Removal of buffer argument of file-local-copy.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26360
diff changeset
5922 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
17d6fe2e2d0f Removal of buffer argument of file-local-copy.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26360
diff changeset
5923 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
17d6fe2e2d0f Removal of buffer argument of file-local-copy.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26360
diff changeset
5924
26360
5370b1c171ef Change in file-locked-p argument.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26359
diff changeset
5925 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
5370b1c171ef Change in file-locked-p argument.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26359
diff changeset
5926 instead of being optional.
5370b1c171ef Change in file-locked-p argument.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26359
diff changeset
5927
26277
32e16b70ae15 New built-in error `text-read-only'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26271
diff changeset
5928 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
32e16b70ae15 New built-in error `text-read-only'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26271
diff changeset
5929 modify read-only text.
32e16b70ae15 New built-in error `text-read-only'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26271
diff changeset
5930
26140
068f7ad41d40 Describe new functions and variables for locales.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents: 26133
diff changeset
5931 ** New functions and variables for locales.
068f7ad41d40 Describe new functions and variables for locales.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents: 26133
diff changeset
5932
068f7ad41d40 Describe new functions and variables for locales.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents: 26133
diff changeset
5933 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
068f7ad41d40 Describe new functions and variables for locales.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents: 26133
diff changeset
5934 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
26525
4df5920724de Rename messages-locale to system-messages-locale
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents: 26467
diff changeset
5935 time functions like strftime. The new variables
4df5920724de Rename messages-locale to system-messages-locale
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents: 26467
diff changeset
5936 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
4df5920724de Rename messages-locale to system-messages-locale
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents: 26467
diff changeset
5937 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
26140
068f7ad41d40 Describe new functions and variables for locales.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents: 26133
diff changeset
5938
068f7ad41d40 Describe new functions and variables for locales.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents: 26133
diff changeset
5939 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
068f7ad41d40 Describe new functions and variables for locales.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents: 26133
diff changeset
5940 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
068f7ad41d40 Describe new functions and variables for locales.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents: 26133
diff changeset
5941 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
26525
4df5920724de Rename messages-locale to system-messages-locale
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents: 26467
diff changeset
5942 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
4df5920724de Rename messages-locale to system-messages-locale
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents: 26467
diff changeset
5943 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
4df5920724de Rename messages-locale to system-messages-locale
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents: 26467
diff changeset
5944 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
4df5920724de Rename messages-locale to system-messages-locale
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents: 26467
diff changeset
5945 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
26140
068f7ad41d40 Describe new functions and variables for locales.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents: 26133
diff changeset
5946
26107
5bdae485eb03 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 26096
diff changeset
5947 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
5bdae485eb03 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 26096
diff changeset
5948 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
5bdae485eb03 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 26096
diff changeset
5949 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
5bdae485eb03 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 26096
diff changeset
5950 start sequences.
5bdae485eb03 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 26096
diff changeset
5951
25910
918acea58309 Add section for change of pixmap-spec-p to bitmap-spec-p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25862
diff changeset
5952 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
918acea58309 Add section for change of pixmap-spec-p to bitmap-spec-p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25862
diff changeset
5953 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
918acea58309 Add section for change of pixmap-spec-p to bitmap-spec-p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 25862
diff changeset
5954
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5955 ** New function `propertize'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5956
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5957 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5958 strings with text properties.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5959
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5960 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5961
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5962 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5963 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5964 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5965 specified value of that property. Example:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5966
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5967 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5968
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5969 ** push and pop macros.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5970
27385
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5971 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5972 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5973 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5974
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5975 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5976 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5977 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5978
27385
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5979 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5980
27387
d0a7127b33e5 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27385
diff changeset
5981 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
d0a7127b33e5 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27385
diff changeset
5982 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
27385
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5983
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5984 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5985 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5986 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5987 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5988
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5989 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5990 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5991 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5992 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
f7b7fdb0f3f4 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 27381
diff changeset
5993
34166
c073ad4159fd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 34125
diff changeset
5994 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
c073ad4159fd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 34125
diff changeset
5995 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
c073ad4159fd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 34125
diff changeset
5996 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
c073ad4159fd *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 34125
diff changeset
5997 or a sign.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5998
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5999 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6000 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6001 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6002 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6003 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6004 space, and DEL.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6005 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6006 and DEL.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6007 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6008 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6009 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6010 [:alpha:] matches letters.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6011 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6012 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6013 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6014 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6015 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6016 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6017 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6018 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6019 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6020 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6021 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6022
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6023 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6024
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6025 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6026
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6027 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6028
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6029 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6030 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6031
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6032 :test TEST
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6033
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6034 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6035 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6036 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6037
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6038 :size SIZE
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6039
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6040 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6041 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6042
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6043 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6044
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6045 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6046 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6047 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6048 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6049 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6050
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6051 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6052
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6053 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6054 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6055 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6056
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6057 :weakness WEAK
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6058
30502
0dca3aa6405a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30483
diff changeset
6059 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
0dca3aa6405a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30483
diff changeset
6060 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
0dca3aa6405a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30483
diff changeset
6061 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
0dca3aa6405a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30483
diff changeset
6062 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
0dca3aa6405a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30483
diff changeset
6063 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6064
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6065 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6066
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6067 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6068
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6069 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6070
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6071 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6072
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6073 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6074
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6075 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6076 values are shared.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6077
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6078 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6079
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6080 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6081
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6082 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6083
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6084 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6085
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6086 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6087
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6088 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6089
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6090 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6091
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6092 Returns the size of TABLE.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6093
30789
68b63779f4df typo fix
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 30788
diff changeset
6094 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6095
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6096 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6097
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6098 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6099
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6100 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6101
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6102 - Function: clrhash TABLE
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6103
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6104 Clear TABLE.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6105
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6106 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6107
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6108 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6109 not found.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6110
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
6111 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6112
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6113 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6114 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6115
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6116 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6117
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6118 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6119
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6120 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6121
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6122 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6123 arguments KEY and VALUE.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6124
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6125 - Function: sxhash OBJ
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6126
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6127 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6128
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6129 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6130
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6131 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6132 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
6133 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6134 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6135 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6136
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6137 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6138
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6139 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6140 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6141 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6142
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6143 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6144 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6145
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6146 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6147 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6148
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6149 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6150 (sxhash (upcase a)))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6151
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
6152 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6153 'case-fold-string-hash))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6154
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6155 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6156
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6157 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6158
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6159 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6160 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6161 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6162
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6163 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6164
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6165 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6166 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6167
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6168 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6169 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6170 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6171 is too short to reach that column.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6172
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6173 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6174 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6175 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6176 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6177
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6178 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6179 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6180 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6181
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6182 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6183 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6184
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6185 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6186 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6187
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6188 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6189 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6190 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6191 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6192 temporary-file-directory instead.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6193
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6194 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6195 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6196 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6197 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6198
36885
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
6199 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
9902636b4757 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36848
diff changeset
6200 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6201
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6202 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6203
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6204 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6205 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6206 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6207
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6208 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6209
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6210 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6211 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6212 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6213 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6214 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6215 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6216
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6217 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6218 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6219 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6220 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6221
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6222 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6223
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6224 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6225 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6226 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6227 result string.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6228
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6229 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6230 string where arguments appear in the result string.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6231
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6232 Example:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6233
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6234 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6235 (s2 "world"))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6236 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6237 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
26034
e7b463705814 Some typos fixed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26030
diff changeset
6238 (format s1 s2))
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6239
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6240 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6241
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6242 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6243
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6244 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6245 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6246 argument in it.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6247
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6248 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6249 (arg "world"))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6250 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6251 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6252 (message msg arg))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6253
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6254 ** Sound support
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6255
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6256 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6257 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6258
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6259 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6260 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6261 to enable sound support.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6262
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6263 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6264 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6265 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6266 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6267 sound to play, before playing the sound.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6268
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6269 The following sound properties are supported:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6270
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6271 - `:file FILE'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6272
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6273 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6274 searched relative to `data-directory'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6275
27148
929f111a6823 Sound with :data.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27145
diff changeset
6276 - `:data DATA'
929f111a6823 Sound with :data.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27145
diff changeset
6277
929f111a6823 Sound with :data.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27145
diff changeset
6278 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
929f111a6823 Sound with :data.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27145
diff changeset
6279 may be present, but not both.
929f111a6823 Sound with :data.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27145
diff changeset
6280
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6281 - `:volume VOLUME'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6282
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6283 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6284 0..1. This property is optional.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6285
33991
b741aa7a2d46 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33990
diff changeset
6286 - `:device DEVICE'
b741aa7a2d46 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33990
diff changeset
6287
b741aa7a2d46 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33990
diff changeset
6288 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
b741aa7a2d46 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33990
diff changeset
6289 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
b741aa7a2d46 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33990
diff changeset
6290
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6291 Other properties are ignored.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6292
33991
b741aa7a2d46 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33990
diff changeset
6293 An alternative interface is called as
b741aa7a2d46 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33990
diff changeset
6294 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
b741aa7a2d46 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33990
diff changeset
6295
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6296 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
26933
73340d009a9f keywordp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26924
diff changeset
6297
73340d009a9f keywordp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26924
diff changeset
6298 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
73340d009a9f keywordp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26924
diff changeset
6299 a keyword symbol.
27145
01abacc81cce Changes to garbage-collect, new var strings-consed,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27144
diff changeset
6300
01abacc81cce Changes to garbage-collect, new var strings-consed,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27144
diff changeset
6301 ** Changes to garbage collection
01abacc81cce Changes to garbage-collect, new var strings-consed,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27144
diff changeset
6302
01abacc81cce Changes to garbage-collect, new var strings-consed,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27144
diff changeset
6303 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
01abacc81cce Changes to garbage-collect, new var strings-consed,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27144
diff changeset
6304 of live and free strings.
01abacc81cce Changes to garbage-collect, new var strings-consed,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27144
diff changeset
6305
01abacc81cce Changes to garbage-collect, new var strings-consed,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27144
diff changeset
6306 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
01abacc81cce Changes to garbage-collect, new var strings-consed,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27144
diff changeset
6307 strings that have been consed so far.
01abacc81cce Changes to garbage-collect, new var strings-consed,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27144
diff changeset
6308
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
6309
29151
fa8f476affa7 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29102
diff changeset
6310 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
fa8f476affa7 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29102
diff changeset
6311 Lisp Manual
fa8f476affa7 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29102
diff changeset
6312
33309
cb1bcdd72f54 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33291
diff changeset
6313 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
cb1bcdd72f54 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33291
diff changeset
6314 mini-windows.
cb1bcdd72f54 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33291
diff changeset
6315
34389
779f5314f5fa Update entry for `pos-visible-in-window-p'.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 34334
diff changeset
6316 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
779f5314f5fa Update entry for `pos-visible-in-window-p'.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 34334
diff changeset
6317 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
779f5314f5fa Update entry for `pos-visible-in-window-p'.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 34334
diff changeset
6318 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
32915
f8e686a581dc Add entry for `pos-visible-in-window-p'.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32913
diff changeset
6319
33309
cb1bcdd72f54 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33291
diff changeset
6320 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
31220
e947c5224fc0 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31183
diff changeset
6321
30222
6468eaa4eaee load-path not customizable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 30219
diff changeset
6322 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
29939
3a5f38acde89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29814
diff changeset
6323
3a5f38acde89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29814
diff changeset
6324 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
3a5f38acde89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29814
diff changeset
6325 image.
3a5f38acde89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29814
diff changeset
6326
3a5f38acde89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29814
diff changeset
6327 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
3a5f38acde89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29814
diff changeset
6328
3a5f38acde89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29814
diff changeset
6329 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
3a5f38acde89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29814
diff changeset
6330
3a5f38acde89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29814
diff changeset
6331 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
3a5f38acde89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29814
diff changeset
6332 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
3a5f38acde89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29814
diff changeset
6333 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
3a5f38acde89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29814
diff changeset
6334 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
3a5f38acde89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29814
diff changeset
6335 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
3a5f38acde89 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29814
diff changeset
6336
31639
1c5bd105d7dc *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31636
diff changeset
6337 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
1c5bd105d7dc *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31636
diff changeset
6338 has a mask bitmap.
1c5bd105d7dc *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31636
diff changeset
6339
1c5bd105d7dc *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31636
diff changeset
6340 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
1c5bd105d7dc *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31636
diff changeset
6341
1c5bd105d7dc *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31636
diff changeset
6342 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
1c5bd105d7dc *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31636
diff changeset
6343 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
1c5bd105d7dc *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31636
diff changeset
6344 or omitted means use the selected frame.
1c5bd105d7dc *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31636
diff changeset
6345
29506
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
6346 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
6347 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
6348
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
6349 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
6350 optional.
096cd250bd8d MULE changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29498
diff changeset
6351
31156
deaa66a2ac5b *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31127
diff changeset
6352 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
deaa66a2ac5b *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31127
diff changeset
6353 below).
29151
fa8f476affa7 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29102
diff changeset
6354
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
6355
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6356 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6357
28634
a2cce25e6c7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28626
diff changeset
6358 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
a2cce25e6c7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28626
diff changeset
6359 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
a2cce25e6c7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28626
diff changeset
6360
a2cce25e6c7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28626
diff changeset
6361 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
a2cce25e6c7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28626
diff changeset
6362 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
a2cce25e6c7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28626
diff changeset
6363 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
a2cce25e6c7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28626
diff changeset
6364 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
a2cce25e6c7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28626
diff changeset
6365 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
a2cce25e6c7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28626
diff changeset
6366 just display it black instead.
a2cce25e6c7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28626
diff changeset
6367
a2cce25e6c7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28626
diff changeset
6368 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
a2cce25e6c7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28626
diff changeset
6369 a line like
a2cce25e6c7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28626
diff changeset
6370
a2cce25e6c7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28626
diff changeset
6371 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
a2cce25e6c7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28626
diff changeset
6372
a2cce25e6c7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28626
diff changeset
6373 in your `.emacs'.
a2cce25e6c7f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28626
diff changeset
6374
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6375 ** New face implementation.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6376
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6377 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6378 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6379
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6380 *** New faces.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6381
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6382 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6383
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6384 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
6385
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6386 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6387 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
6388
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6389 3. Font height in 1/10pt
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
6390
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6391 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
6392
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6393 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
6394
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6395 6. Foreground color.
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
6396
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6397 7. Background color.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6398
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6399 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6400
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6401 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6402
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6403 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6404
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6405 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6406
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6407 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6408 color.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6409
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6410 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6411 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6412
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6413 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6414 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6415 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6416 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
35863
534be6e166a6 Yet another bunch of typo fizes from Juanma Barranquero <lektu@uol.com.br>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35862
diff changeset
6417 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6418 attributes mentioned above.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6419
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6420 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6421 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6422 created frames.
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
6423
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6424 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6425 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6426 `fully-specified'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6427
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6428 *** Face merging.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6429
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6430 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6431 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6432 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6433 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6434 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6435 results in a fully-specified face.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6436
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6437 *** Face realization.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6438
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6439 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6440 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6441 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6442 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6443 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6444 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6445
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6446 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6447 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6448 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6449 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6450
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6451 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6452 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6453 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6454 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6455 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6456
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6457 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6458 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6459 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6460 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6461 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6462 Emacs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6463
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6464 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6465 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6466 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6467 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6468
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6469 **** Clearing face caches.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6470
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6471 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6472 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6473 unused fonts.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6474
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6475 *** Font selection.
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
6476
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6477 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6478 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6479 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6480
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6481 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6482 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6483 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6484 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6485 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6486
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6487 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6488 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6489 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6490
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6491 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6492
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6493 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6494 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6495 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6496 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6497 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6498 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6499 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6500
33373
701833d4b661 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33364
diff changeset
6501 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
701833d4b661 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33364
diff changeset
6502 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
35297
e268b7b500f0 Changes for makefile support in etags.
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 35278
diff changeset
6503 doesn't exist.
34630
3d5061d0047f *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 34617
diff changeset
6504
3d5061d0047f *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 34617
diff changeset
6505 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
35680
1a6073992224 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35665
diff changeset
6506 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
34630
3d5061d0047f *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 34617
diff changeset
6507 registry.
3d5061d0047f *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 34617
diff changeset
6508
35680
1a6073992224 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35665
diff changeset
6509 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
34630
3d5061d0047f *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 34617
diff changeset
6510 slightly different.
3d5061d0047f *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 34617
diff changeset
6511
3d5061d0047f *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 34617
diff changeset
6512 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
3d5061d0047f *** empty log message ***
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents: 34617
diff changeset
6513
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6514
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6515 **** Scalable fonts
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6516
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6517 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6518 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6519 servers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6520
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6521 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
26034
e7b463705814 Some typos fixed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26030
diff changeset
6522 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6523 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6524 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6525 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6526 that list. Example:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6527
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6528 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6529
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6530 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6531
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6532 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6533
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6534 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6535
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6536 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6537 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6538 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6539
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6540 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6541 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6542 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6543 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6544 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6545 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6546 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6547 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6548 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6549 of the face font sort order.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6550
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
6551 - Function: x-font-family-list
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6552
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6553 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6554 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6555 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6556 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6557
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6558 - Variable: font-list-limit
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6559
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6560 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6561 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6562 matching font. The default is currently 100.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6563
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6564 *** Setting face attributes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6565
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6566 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6567 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6568 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6569 `face-attribute'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6570
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6571 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6572 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6573
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6574 The following attributes are recognized:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6575
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6576 `:family'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6577
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6578 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6579 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6580 and `?' are allowed.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6581
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6582 `:width'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6583
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6584 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6585 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6586 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6587 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6588
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6589 `:height'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6590
31183
cb5d69bcd655 Add description of new :inherit face attribute, and additional legal
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 31156
diff changeset
6591 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
cb5d69bcd655 Add description of new :inherit face attribute, and additional legal
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 31156
diff changeset
6592 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
cb5d69bcd655 Add description of new :inherit face attribute, and additional legal
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 31156
diff changeset
6593 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
cb5d69bcd655 Add description of new :inherit face attribute, and additional legal
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 31156
diff changeset
6594 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6595
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6596 `:weight'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6597
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6598 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6599 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6600 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6601
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6602 `:slant'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6603
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6604 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6605 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6606 `reverse-oblique'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6607
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6608 `:foreground', `:background'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6609
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6610 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6611
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6612 `:underline'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6613
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6614 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6615 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6616 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6617 don't underline.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6618
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6619 `:overline'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6620
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6621 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6622 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6623 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6624 overline.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6625
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6626 `:strike-through'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6627
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6628 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6629 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6630 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6631 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6632
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6633 `:box'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6634
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6635 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6636 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6637 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6638 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6639 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6640 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6641 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6642 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6643 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6644 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6645 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6646 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6647 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6648 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6649 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6650 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6651 box.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6652
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6653 `:inverse-video'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6654
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6655 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6656 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6657
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6658 `:stipple'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6659
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6660 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6661 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6662 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6663 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6664 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6665 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6666
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6667 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6668 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6669
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6670 `:font'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6671
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6672 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6673 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6674 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6675 versions of Emacs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6676
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6677 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6678 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6679 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6680
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6681 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6682 `defface'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6683
31183
cb5d69bcd655 Add description of new :inherit face attribute, and additional legal
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 31156
diff changeset
6684 `:inherit'
cb5d69bcd655 Add description of new :inherit face attribute, and additional legal
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 31156
diff changeset
6685
cb5d69bcd655 Add description of new :inherit face attribute, and additional legal
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 31156
diff changeset
6686 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
cb5d69bcd655 Add description of new :inherit face attribute, and additional legal
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 31156
diff changeset
6687 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
cb5d69bcd655 Add description of new :inherit face attribute, and additional legal
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 31156
diff changeset
6688 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
cb5d69bcd655 Add description of new :inherit face attribute, and additional legal
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 31156
diff changeset
6689
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6690 *** Face attributes and X resources
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6691
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6692 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6693 from X resources:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6694
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6695 Face attribute X resource class
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6696 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6697 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6698 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6699 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6700 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6701 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6702 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6703 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6704 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6705 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6706 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6707 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6708 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6709 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
6710 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6711 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6712 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6713 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6714 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6715 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6716
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6717 *** Text property `face'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6718
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6719 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6720 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6721 specification can be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6722
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6723 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6724
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6725 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6726 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6727 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6728 for face attribute names.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6729
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6730 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6731 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6732 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6733
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6734 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6735
27092
60f5b0f50db9 Document the unified frame-independent support for colors and faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27076
diff changeset
6736 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
60f5b0f50db9 Document the unified frame-independent support for colors and faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27076
diff changeset
6737 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
60f5b0f50db9 Document the unified frame-independent support for colors and faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27076
diff changeset
6738 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6739 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
27092
60f5b0f50db9 Document the unified frame-independent support for colors and faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27076
diff changeset
6740 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6741 used to clear the mapping table.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6742
27092
60f5b0f50db9 Document the unified frame-independent support for colors and faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27076
diff changeset
6743 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
60f5b0f50db9 Document the unified frame-independent support for colors and faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27076
diff changeset
6744
60f5b0f50db9 Document the unified frame-independent support for colors and faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27076
diff changeset
6745 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
60f5b0f50db9 Document the unified frame-independent support for colors and faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27076
diff changeset
6746 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
60f5b0f50db9 Document the unified frame-independent support for colors and faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27076
diff changeset
6747 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
60f5b0f50db9 Document the unified frame-independent support for colors and faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27076
diff changeset
6748 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
60f5b0f50db9 Document the unified frame-independent support for colors and faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27076
diff changeset
6749 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
60f5b0f50db9 Document the unified frame-independent support for colors and faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27076
diff changeset
6750 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
60f5b0f50db9 Document the unified frame-independent support for colors and faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27076
diff changeset
6751 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
60f5b0f50db9 Document the unified frame-independent support for colors and faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27076
diff changeset
6752 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
60f5b0f50db9 Document the unified frame-independent support for colors and faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27076
diff changeset
6753 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
60f5b0f50db9 Document the unified frame-independent support for colors and faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27076
diff changeset
6754 modify their color-related behavior.
60f5b0f50db9 Document the unified frame-independent support for colors and faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27076
diff changeset
6755
60f5b0f50db9 Document the unified frame-independent support for colors and faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27076
diff changeset
6756 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
60f5b0f50db9 Document the unified frame-independent support for colors and faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27076
diff changeset
6757 any frame type.
60f5b0f50db9 Document the unified frame-independent support for colors and faces.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27076
diff changeset
6758
27573
32f4457e5501 Document functions which return display capabilities.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27533
diff changeset
6759 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
32f4457e5501 Document functions which return display capabilities.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27533
diff changeset
6760
32f4457e5501 Document functions which return display capabilities.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27533
diff changeset
6761 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
32f4457e5501 Document functions which return display capabilities.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27533
diff changeset
6762 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
32f4457e5501 Document functions which return display capabilities.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27533
diff changeset
6763 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
32f4457e5501 Document functions which return display capabilities.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27533
diff changeset
6764 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
32f4457e5501 Document functions which return display capabilities.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27533
diff changeset
6765 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
32f4457e5501 Document functions which return display capabilities.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27533
diff changeset
6766 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
32f4457e5501 Document functions which return display capabilities.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27533
diff changeset
6767 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
32f4457e5501 Document functions which return display capabilities.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27533
diff changeset
6768 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
32f4457e5501 Document functions which return display capabilities.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27533
diff changeset
6769 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
32f4457e5501 Document functions which return display capabilities.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 27533
diff changeset
6770
38471
83fa544a8070 Document display-images-p.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38468
diff changeset
6771 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
83fa544a8070 Document display-images-p.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38468
diff changeset
6772 display can display image files.
83fa544a8070 Document display-images-p.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38468
diff changeset
6773
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6774 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
26062
fd35581d53c1 Add Miles Bader's description of fields.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26034
diff changeset
6775
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6776 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
33693
efa325b58d74 Mention that `minibuffer-prompt-properties' can be used to disallow
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 33627
diff changeset
6777 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
efa325b58d74 Mention that `minibuffer-prompt-properties' can be used to disallow
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 33627
diff changeset
6778 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
efa325b58d74 Mention that `minibuffer-prompt-properties' can be used to disallow
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 33627
diff changeset
6779 `Inviolable' option.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6780
43184
de686446afd2 Fix description of minibuffer-prompt-end.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents: 43159
diff changeset
6781 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6782 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
43184
de686446afd2 Fix description of minibuffer-prompt-end.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents: 43159
diff changeset
6783 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6784
26062
fd35581d53c1 Add Miles Bader's description of fields.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26034
diff changeset
6785 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
fd35581d53c1 Add Miles Bader's description of fields.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26034
diff changeset
6786
fd35581d53c1 Add Miles Bader's description of fields.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26034
diff changeset
6787 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
fd35581d53c1 Add Miles Bader's description of fields.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26034
diff changeset
6788 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
30776
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6789 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
26062
fd35581d53c1 Add Miles Bader's description of fields.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26034
diff changeset
6790
26300
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6791 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
26062
fd35581d53c1 Add Miles Bader's description of fields.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26034
diff changeset
6792 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
26300
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6793 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
26062
fd35581d53c1 Add Miles Bader's description of fields.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26034
diff changeset
6794 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
27144
46becbc67703 inhibit-field-text-motion
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27136
diff changeset
6795 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
46becbc67703 inhibit-field-text-motion
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27136
diff changeset
6796 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
46becbc67703 inhibit-field-text-motion
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27136
diff changeset
6797 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
46becbc67703 inhibit-field-text-motion
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27136
diff changeset
6798 functions.
26062
fd35581d53c1 Add Miles Bader's description of fields.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26034
diff changeset
6799
fd35581d53c1 Add Miles Bader's description of fields.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26034
diff changeset
6800 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
26300
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6801 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
26062
fd35581d53c1 Add Miles Bader's description of fields.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26034
diff changeset
6802 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6803
26300
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6804 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6805
30776
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6806 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
26300
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6807
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6808 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
30776
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6809
26300
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6810 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6811 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
35847
83b8f5ad1f97 Several typos fixed. From Juanma Barranquero <lektu@uol.com.br>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35784
diff changeset
6812 constrained position if that is different.
26300
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6813
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6814 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6815 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6816 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
30776
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6817 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
26300
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6818 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6819 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
30776
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6820 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6821 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6822 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
26300
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6823
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6824 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6825 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6826 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6827 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6828 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6829
30776
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6830 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6831 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6832
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6833 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6834
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6835 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6836
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6837 Delete the field surrounding POS.
26300
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6838 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
30776
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6839 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
26300
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6840
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6841 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6842
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6843 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6844 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
30776
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6845 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6846 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
26300
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6847 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6848
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6849 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6850
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6851 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6852 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
30776
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6853 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6854 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
26300
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6855 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6856
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6857 - Function: field-string &optional POS
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6858
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6859 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6860 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
30776
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6861 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
26300
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6862
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6863 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6864
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6865 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6866 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
30776
ec759fa10ad9 Update `fields' entry.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 30759
diff changeset
6867 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
26300
25356c16306f Expanded description of `field' property from Miles Bader.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26292
diff changeset
6868
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6869 ** Image support.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6870
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6871 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6872 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6873 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6874 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6875
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6876 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6877 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6878 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6879 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6880 area.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6881
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6882 IMAGE is an image specification.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6883
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6884 *** Image specifications
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6885
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6886 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6887 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6888 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
26403
03830fdf5186 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26397
diff changeset
6889 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
03830fdf5186 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26397
diff changeset
6890 described below are ignored.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6891
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6892 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6893
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6894 `:ascent ASCENT'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6895
28789
b69d5f20b837 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28776
diff changeset
6896 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
b69d5f20b837 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28776
diff changeset
6897 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
30483
05fc373ff5b8 mention `float-time' and the remote file modtime check
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 30482
diff changeset
6898 to use for its ascent.
28789
b69d5f20b837 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28776
diff changeset
6899
b69d5f20b837 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28776
diff changeset
6900 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
b69d5f20b837 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28776
diff changeset
6901 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
b69d5f20b837 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28776
diff changeset
6902
30483
05fc373ff5b8 mention `float-time' and the remote file modtime check
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 30482
diff changeset
6903 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
29151
fa8f476affa7 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29102
diff changeset
6904 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
fa8f476affa7 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29102
diff changeset
6905 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
fa8f476affa7 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29102
diff changeset
6906 overlays that apply to the image.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6907
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6908 `:margin MARGIN'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6909
35278
80050ac10dbf *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35250
diff changeset
6910 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
80050ac10dbf *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35250
diff changeset
6911 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
80050ac10dbf *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35250
diff changeset
6912 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6913
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6914 `:relief RELIEF'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6915
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6916 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6917 around an image.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6918
35364
19c93f3ebdce *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35326
diff changeset
6919 `:conversion ALGO'
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6920
31636
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6921 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6922
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6923 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6924 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6925
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6926 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6927 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6928 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6929 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6930 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6931 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6932 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6933 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6934 below.
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6935
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6936 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6937 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6938 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6939
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6940 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6941 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6942 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6943 of the factors' absolute values.
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6944
31858
269d69b69fe4 Update hideshow.el section.
Thien-Thi Nguyen <ttn@gnuvola.org>
parents: 31827
diff changeset
6945 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
31636
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6946
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6947 (1 0 0
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6948 0 0 0
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6949 9 9 -1)
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6950
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6951 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6952
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6953 ( 2 -1 0
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6954 -1 0 1
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6955 0 1 -2)
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6956
31728
1b791fcfaa10 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31641
diff changeset
6957 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
1b791fcfaa10 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31641
diff changeset
6958 ``disabled''.
1b791fcfaa10 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31641
diff changeset
6959
31636
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6960 `:mask MASK'
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6961
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6962 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6963 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6964 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6965 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
35680
1a6073992224 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35665
diff changeset
6966 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
31636
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6967 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6968 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6969 image.
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6970
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6971 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6972 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
3ff1515f7c7a *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31561
diff changeset
6973 `:mask nil'.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6974
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6975 `:file FILE'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6976
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6977 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6978 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6979 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6980 may be present in the image specification.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6981
27076
40c18bc759e9 Change description of :data for images.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27055
diff changeset
6982 `:data DATA'
40c18bc759e9 Change description of :data for images.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27055
diff changeset
6983
40c18bc759e9 Change description of :data for images.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27055
diff changeset
6984 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
40c18bc759e9 Change description of :data for images.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27055
diff changeset
6985 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
40c18bc759e9 Change description of :data for images.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27055
diff changeset
6986 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
40c18bc759e9 Change description of :data for images.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27055
diff changeset
6987 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
40c18bc759e9 Change description of :data for images.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27055
diff changeset
6988
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6989 *** Supported image types
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6990
26034
e7b463705814 Some typos fixed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26030
diff changeset
6991 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6992
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6993 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
49520
de390d032ae7 Fix typos in description of image properties.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 49493
diff changeset
6994 properties supported are:
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6995
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6996 `:foreground FG'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6997
37948
3025939a637d Add that PBM and XPM image specs may have :foreground nil, and
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37933
diff changeset
6998 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
49520
de390d032ae7 Fix typos in description of image properties.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 49493
diff changeset
6999 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7000
32572
99b7b88db80c Fix a typo.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 32551
diff changeset
7001 `:background BG'
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7002
49520
de390d032ae7 Fix typos in description of image properties.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 49493
diff changeset
7003 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
37948
3025939a637d Add that PBM and XPM image specs may have :foreground nil, and
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37933
diff changeset
7004 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7005
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7006 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7007 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7008 instead of a `:file' property.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7009
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7010 `:width WIDTH'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7011
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7012 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7013
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7014 `:height HEIGHT'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7015
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7016 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7017
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7018 `:data DATA'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7019
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7020 DATA must be either
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7021
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7022 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7023 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7024
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7025 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7026
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7027 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7028 bitmap.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7029
28748
6d96f2643b05 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28724
diff changeset
7030 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
6d96f2643b05 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28724
diff changeset
7031 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
6d96f2643b05 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28724
diff changeset
7032 in the file.
6d96f2643b05 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28724
diff changeset
7033
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7034 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7035
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7036 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7037 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7038 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7039 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7040
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7041 Additional image properties supported are:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7042
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7043 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7044
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7045 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7046 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7047 name.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7048
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7049 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7050 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7051
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7052 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7053 to display compressed images.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7054
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7055 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7056
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7057 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
32551
329cbf266d5c Add description of :foreground and :background to PBM images.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 32511
diff changeset
7058 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
49520
de390d032ae7 Fix typos in description of image properties.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 49493
diff changeset
7059 mono images are:
32551
329cbf266d5c Add description of :foreground and :background to PBM images.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 32511
diff changeset
7060
329cbf266d5c Add description of :foreground and :background to PBM images.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 32511
diff changeset
7061 `:foreground FG'
329cbf266d5c Add description of :foreground and :background to PBM images.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 32511
diff changeset
7062
37948
3025939a637d Add that PBM and XPM image specs may have :foreground nil, and
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37933
diff changeset
7063 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
49520
de390d032ae7 Fix typos in description of image properties.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 49493
diff changeset
7064 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
32551
329cbf266d5c Add description of :foreground and :background to PBM images.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 32511
diff changeset
7065
329cbf266d5c Add description of :foreground and :background to PBM images.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 32511
diff changeset
7066 `:background FG'
329cbf266d5c Add description of :foreground and :background to PBM images.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 32511
diff changeset
7067
49520
de390d032ae7 Fix typos in description of image properties.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 49493
diff changeset
7068 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
37948
3025939a637d Add that PBM and XPM image specs may have :foreground nil, and
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37933
diff changeset
7069 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7070
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7071 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7072
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7073 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
49520
de390d032ae7 Fix typos in description of image properties.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 49493
diff changeset
7074 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
de390d032ae7 Fix typos in description of image properties.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 49493
diff changeset
7075 properties defined.
27055
f43dabd831f2 Support :data for JPEG.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27045
diff changeset
7076
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7077 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7078
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7079 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7080 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7081 properties defined.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7082
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7083 **** GIF, image type `gif'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7084
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7085 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7086 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7087
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7088 Additional image properties supported are:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7089
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7090 `:index INDEX'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7091
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7092 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
35680
1a6073992224 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35665
diff changeset
7093 multi-image GIF file. An error is signaled if INDEX is too large.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7094
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7095 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7096 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7097 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7098 every 0.1 seconds.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7099
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7100 (defun show-anim (file max)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7101 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7102 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7103
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7104 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7105 (when (= idx max)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7106 (setq idx 0))
27076
40c18bc759e9 Change description of :data for images.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27055
diff changeset
7107 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7108 (save-excursion
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7109 (set-buffer buffer)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7110 (goto-char (point-min))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7111 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7112 (insert-image img "x"))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7113 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7114
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7115 **** PNG, image type `png'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7116
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7117 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7118 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7119 properties defined.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7120
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7121 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7122
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7123 Additional image properties supported are:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7124
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7125 `:pt-width WIDTH'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7126
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7127 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
26034
e7b463705814 Some typos fixed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26030
diff changeset
7128 integer. This is a required property.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7129
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7130 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7131
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7132 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
26034
e7b463705814 Some typos fixed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26030
diff changeset
7133 must be a integer. This is an required property.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7134
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7135 `:bounding-box BOX'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7136
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7137 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7138 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7139 files. This is an required property.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7140
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7141 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7142 lisp/gs.el.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7143
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7144 *** Lisp interface.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7145
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
7146 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
7147 which are supported in the current configuration.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7148
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7149 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7150 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7151 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
28759
069d241f19bc *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28757
diff changeset
7152 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
069d241f19bc *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28757
diff changeset
7153 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7154
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7155 *** Simplified image API, image.el
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7156
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7157 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7158 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7159 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7160 define an image based on available image types. The functions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7161 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7162 buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7163
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7164 ** Display margins.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7165
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7166 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7167 and images.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7168
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7169 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7170 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7171 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7172 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7173 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7174 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7175 of the display margins.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7176
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7177 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7178 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7179 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7180 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7181 in this file).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7182
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7183 ** Help display
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7184
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7185 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7186 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7187 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7188 that have a `help-echo' property.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7189
30219
87d8ca1f4b52 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30206
diff changeset
7190 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
30305
84ff1994e9d1 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30296
diff changeset
7191 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
30372
2047c9586451 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30357
diff changeset
7192 the window in which the help was found.
2047c9586451 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30357
diff changeset
7193
2047c9586451 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30357
diff changeset
7194 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
2047c9586451 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30357
diff changeset
7195 `help-echo' text property was found.
2047c9586451 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30357
diff changeset
7196
2047c9586451 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30357
diff changeset
7197 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
2047c9586451 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30357
diff changeset
7198 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
2047c9586451 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30357
diff changeset
7199
2047c9586451 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30357
diff changeset
7200 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
30467
26afdae5ea13 --disable-largefile, 64-bit solaris
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 30445
diff changeset
7201 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
30372
2047c9586451 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30357
diff changeset
7202 mouse.
30219
87d8ca1f4b52 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30206
diff changeset
7203
87d8ca1f4b52 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30206
diff changeset
7204 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
87d8ca1f4b52 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30206
diff changeset
7205 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
87d8ca1f4b52 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30206
diff changeset
7206
87d8ca1f4b52 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30206
diff changeset
7207 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
87d8ca1f4b52 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30206
diff changeset
7208 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
87d8ca1f4b52 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30206
diff changeset
7209 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
87d8ca1f4b52 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30206
diff changeset
7210 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
87d8ca1f4b52 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30206
diff changeset
7211 used as help string.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7212
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7213 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
30339
70d759570f7a C-down-mouse-3. Move concat change.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 30319
diff changeset
7214 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
70d759570f7a C-down-mouse-3. Move concat change.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 30319
diff changeset
7215 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7216
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7217 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7218
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7219 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7220 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7221
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7222 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7223 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7224 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7225 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7226 used.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7227
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
7228 (global-set-key [A-down]
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
7229 #'(lambda ()
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7230 (interactive)
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
7231 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7232 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
7233 (global-set-key [A-up]
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7234 #'(lambda ()
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7235 (interactive)
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
7236 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7237 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7238
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7239 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7240
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7241 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7242 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7243 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7244 is called with one argument, POS.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7245
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7246 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7247 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7248 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7249 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7250 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7251
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7252 ** Tool bar support.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7253
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7254 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7255 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7256 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7257 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7258 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7259 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7260
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7261 *** Tool bar item definitions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7262
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7263 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7264 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7265 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
7266
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7267 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7268 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7269 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7270 property (see below).
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
7271
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7272 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7273 binding are currently ignored.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7274
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7275 The following properties are recognized:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7276
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7277 `:enable FORM'.
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
7278
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7279 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7280 or disabled.
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
7281
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7282 `:visible FORM'
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
7283
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7284 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
7285
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7286 `:filter FUNCTION'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7287
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7288 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7289 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7290 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
7291
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7292 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7293
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7294 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7295 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
7296
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7297 `:image IMAGES'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7298
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7299 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7300 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7301 meaning of each of the four elements:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7302
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7303 Index Use when item is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7304 ----------------------------------------
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7305 0 enabled and selected
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7306 1 enabled and deselected
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7307 2 disabled and selected
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7308 3 disabled and deselected
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
7309
28946
f100c3d709e4 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28919
diff changeset
7310 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
f100c3d709e4 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28919
diff changeset
7311 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
f100c3d709e4 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28919
diff changeset
7312
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7313 `:help HELP-STRING'.
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
7314
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7315 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7316 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7317
31641
15837f59a747 Strokes update. Toolbar stuff.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31639
diff changeset
7318 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
31741
dcff79c941d1 tool-bar, latin1-display
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31728
diff changeset
7319 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
dcff79c941d1 tool-bar, latin1-display
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31728
diff changeset
7320 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
dcff79c941d1 tool-bar, latin1-display
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31728
diff changeset
7321 menu bar.
31641
15837f59a747 Strokes update. Toolbar stuff.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 31639
diff changeset
7322
33484
e64bda3bd077 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33411
diff changeset
7323 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
e64bda3bd077 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33411
diff changeset
7324 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
e64bda3bd077 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33411
diff changeset
7325 buffer-locally to override the global map.
e64bda3bd077 *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 33411
diff changeset
7326
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7327 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7328
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7329 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7330 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7331 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7332
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
7333 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7334 raised when the mouse moves over them.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7335
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7336 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7337 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
35278
80050ac10dbf *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35250
diff changeset
7338 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
80050ac10dbf *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35250
diff changeset
7339 vertical margins . Default is 1.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7340
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7341 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7342 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7343
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7344 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7345
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7346 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
7347 a tool bar item. If
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7348
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7349 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7350 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7351 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7352
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7353 is the original tool bar item definition, then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7354
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7355 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7356
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7357 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7358 item.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7359
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7360 ** Mode line changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7361
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7362 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7363
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7364 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7365 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7366 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7367
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7368 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7369 a `local-map' text property.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7370
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7371 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7372 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7373
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7374 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7375 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7376 `local-map' property.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7377
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7378 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7379 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7380 example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7381
26359
d2970b5d3b72 Add mode line element '(:eval FORM)'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26322
diff changeset
7382 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
d2970b5d3b72 Add mode line element '(:eval FORM)'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26322
diff changeset
7383 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
d2970b5d3b72 Add mode line element '(:eval FORM)'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 26322
diff changeset
7384
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7385 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7386 variable mode-line-format to nil.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7387
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7388 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7389
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7390 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7391 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7392 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7393 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7394 line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7395
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7396 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7397 `header-line'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7398
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7399 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7400 position in the header-line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7401
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7402 ** Text property `display'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7403
31827
7c50babd3f4f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31816
diff changeset
7404 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
7c50babd3f4f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31816
diff changeset
7405 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
7c50babd3f4f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31816
diff changeset
7406 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
7c50babd3f4f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31816
diff changeset
7407 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7408 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7409
31827
7c50babd3f4f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31816
diff changeset
7410 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
7c50babd3f4f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31816
diff changeset
7411
7c50babd3f4f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31816
diff changeset
7412 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
7c50babd3f4f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31816
diff changeset
7413 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
7c50babd3f4f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31816
diff changeset
7414
7c50babd3f4f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31816
diff changeset
7415 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
7c50babd3f4f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31816
diff changeset
7416 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
7c50babd3f4f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31816
diff changeset
7417 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
7c50babd3f4f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31816
diff changeset
7418 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
7c50babd3f4f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31816
diff changeset
7419 simpler form STRING as property value.
7c50babd3f4f *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 31816
diff changeset
7420
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7421 *** Variable width and height spaces
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7422
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7423 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7424 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7425 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7426 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7427 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7428 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7429 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7430
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7431 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7432 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7433 properties described below.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7434
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7435 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7436 characters having the `display' property.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7437
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7438 - :width WIDTH
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7439
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7440 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7441 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7442
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7443 - :relative-width FACTOR
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7444
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7445 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7446 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7447 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7448 width of that character by FACTOR.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7449
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7450 - :align-to HPOS
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7451
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7452 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7453 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7454
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7455 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7456
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7457 - :height HEIGHT
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7458
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7459 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7460 normal line height.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7461
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7462 - :relative-height FACTOR
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7463
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7464 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7465 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7466
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7467 - :ascent ASCENT
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7468
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7469 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7470 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7471 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7472 equal to 100.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7473
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7474 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7475
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7476 *** Images
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7477
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7478 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7479 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7480 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7481 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7482 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7483 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7484 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7485 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7486 as display specification.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7487
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7488 *** Other display properties
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7489
33499
178c626ccf39 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33484
diff changeset
7490 - (space-width FACTOR)
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7491
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7492 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7493 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7494 integer or float.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7495
33499
178c626ccf39 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33484
diff changeset
7496 - (height HEIGHT)
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7497
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7498 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7499
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7500 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7501 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7502 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7503 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7504 a font is available counts as a step.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7505
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7506 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7507 as tall as the frame's default font.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7508
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7509 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7510 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7511
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7512 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7513 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7514
33499
178c626ccf39 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33484
diff changeset
7515 - (raise FACTOR)
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7516
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7517 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7518 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7519 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7520 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
33499
178c626ccf39 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 33484
diff changeset
7521 `height' subproperty.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7522
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7523 *** Conditional display properties
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7524
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7525 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
39031
f5db16d9b787 Change conditional display property API description.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38989
diff changeset
7526 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
f5db16d9b787 Change conditional display property API description.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38989
diff changeset
7527 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
f5db16d9b787 Change conditional display property API description.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38989
diff changeset
7528 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
f5db16d9b787 Change conditional display property API description.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38989
diff changeset
7529 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
f5db16d9b787 Change conditional display property API description.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38989
diff changeset
7530 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
f5db16d9b787 Change conditional display property API description.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38989
diff changeset
7531 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
f5db16d9b787 Change conditional display property API description.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38989
diff changeset
7532 different when object is a string.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7533
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7534 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
39031
f5db16d9b787 Change conditional display property API description.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38989
diff changeset
7535 `(when t . SPEC)'.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7536
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7537 ** New menu separator types.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7538
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7539 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7540 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7541 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7542 to specify other menu separator types.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7543
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7544 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7545
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7546 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7547 separator occurs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7548
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7549 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7550
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7551 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7552
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7553 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7554
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7555 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7556
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7557 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7558
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7559 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7560
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7561 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7562
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7563 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7564
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7565 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7566
35862
9604ca6b3728 More typos from Juanma Barranquero <lektu@uol.com.br>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35847
diff changeset
7567 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7568 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7569
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7570 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7571
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7572 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7573
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7574 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7575
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7576 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7577
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7578 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7579
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7580 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7581
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7582 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7583
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7584 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7585
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7586 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7587
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7588 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7589
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7590 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7591
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7592 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7593
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7594 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7595
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7596 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7597
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7598 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7599 the corresponding single-line separators.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7600
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7601 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7602
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7603 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7604 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7605 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7606 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7607 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7608 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7609 default foreground is black.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7610
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7611 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7612 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7613 `ScrollBarBackground').
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7614
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7615 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7616 settings for scroll bar colors.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7617
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7618 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7619 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7620
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7621 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7622 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7623 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7624 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7625 the original window start.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7626
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7627 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7628 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7629 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7630
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7631 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7632
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7633 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7634 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7635 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7636 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7637
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7638 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7639 fixed-width and fixed-height.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7640
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7641 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7642
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7643 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7644 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7645 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7646 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7647 temporarily to nil, for example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7648
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7649 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7650 (enlarge-window 10))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7651
26264
Francesco Potortì <pot@gnu.org>
parents: 26171
diff changeset
7652 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7653 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
28094
e1e48e0663f6 Mention cursor-type support on MS-DOS terminals.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 28063
diff changeset
7654
e1e48e0663f6 Mention cursor-type support on MS-DOS terminals.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 28063
diff changeset
7655 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
e1e48e0663f6 Mention cursor-type support on MS-DOS terminals.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 28063
diff changeset
7656 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
e1e48e0663f6 Mention cursor-type support on MS-DOS terminals.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 28063
diff changeset
7657 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
e1e48e0663f6 Mention cursor-type support on MS-DOS terminals.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 28063
diff changeset
7658 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
e1e48e0663f6 Mention cursor-type support on MS-DOS terminals.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 28063
diff changeset
7659 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
e1e48e0663f6 Mention cursor-type support on MS-DOS terminals.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 28063
diff changeset
7660 support a vertical-bar cursor).
30786
550344dcef43 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30781
diff changeset
7661
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7662
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
7663
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7664 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7665
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7666 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7667 input.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7668
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7669 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7670
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7671 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7672
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7673 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7674 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7675 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7676 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7677 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7678
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7679 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7680 been added.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7681
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
7682
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7683 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7684
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7685 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7686
35469
Sam Steingold <sds@gnu.org>
parents: 35460
diff changeset
7687
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
7688
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7689 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7690
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7691 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7692 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
7693
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7694 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7695
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7696 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7697
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7698 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7699 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7700 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7701
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7702 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7703 is the one that is used.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7704
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7705 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7706 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7707 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7708 separate from the command's regular output.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7709 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7710 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7711 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7712 the buffer name.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7713
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7714 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7715 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7716 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7717 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7718
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7719 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7720 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7721 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7722 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7723
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7724 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7725 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7726 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7727 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7728
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7729 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7730 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7731 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7732 they never ignore case.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7733
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7734 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7735 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7736 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7737 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7738 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7739 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7740 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7741
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7742 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7743 the same format that was used in the file before.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7744
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7745 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7746 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7747
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7748 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7749 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7750 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7751
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7752 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7753 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7754 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7755 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7756 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7757 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7758 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7759
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7760 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7761 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7762 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7763 format. You can now customize these variables.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7764
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7765 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7766 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7767 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7768 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7769
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7770 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7771 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7772 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7773
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7774 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7775 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7776 doesn't have any effect.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7777
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7778 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7779 not one per buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7780
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7781 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7782 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7783 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7784
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7785 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7786 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7787 `auto-show-mode' command.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7788
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7789 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7790 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7791 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7792 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7793 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7794
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7795 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7796 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7797
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7798 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7799 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7800 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7801
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7802 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7803 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7804 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7805 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7806
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7807 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7808
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7809 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7810 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7811 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7812 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7813 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7814
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7815 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7816 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7817
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7818 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7819 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7820 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7821 `?' on other systems.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7822
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7823 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7824 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7825 Unix.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7826
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7827 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7828 current codepage when it starts.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7829
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7830 ** Mail changes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7831
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7832 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7833 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7834 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7835 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7836 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7837 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7838 latin-1:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7839
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7840 MIME-version: 1.0
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7841 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7842 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7843
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7844 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7845 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7846 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7847 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7848 buffer-file-coding-system.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7849
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7850 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7851 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7852 mail.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7853
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7854 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7855 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7856 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7857 list of possible coding systems.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7858
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7859 ** CC Mode changes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7860
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7861 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7862 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7863 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7864 docstring for details.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7865
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7866 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7867 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7868 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7869 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7870 lineup functions use this feature currently.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7871
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7872 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7873 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7874
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7875 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7876 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7877
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7878 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7879 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7880 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7881 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7882 anonymous classes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7883
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7884 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7885 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7886
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7887 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7888 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7889 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7890 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7891
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7892 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7893 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7894 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7895 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7896 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7897
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7898 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7899
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7900 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7901
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7902 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7903 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7904
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7905 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7906
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7907 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7908 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7909 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7910 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7911 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7912
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7913 ** Gnus changes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7914
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7915 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7916 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7917 Gnus manual for the full story.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7918
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7919 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7920 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7921 group, which is created automatically.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7923 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7924 values.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7925
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7926 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7927
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7928 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7929 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7930
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7931 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7932 `C-u C-c C-c'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7933
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7934 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7935
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7936 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7937 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7938
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7939 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7940
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7941 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7942 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7943
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7944 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7945 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7946
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7947 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7948 control over simplification.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7949
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7950 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7951
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7952 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7953 limit.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7954
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7955 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7956
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7957 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7958
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7959 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7960 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7961 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7962
35680
1a6073992224 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35665
diff changeset
7963 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7964 `a' forces normal posting method.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7965
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7966 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7967 -- `W d'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7968
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7969 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7970 to a non-nil value.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7971
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7972 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7973 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7974
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7975 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7976 has been added.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7977
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7978 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7979
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7980 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7981
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7982 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7983 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7984
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7985 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7986 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7987
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7988 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7989
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7990 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7991 been added.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7992
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7993 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7994 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7995
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7996 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7997 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7998
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
7999 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8000
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8001 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8002
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8003 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8004
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8005 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8006
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8007 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8008 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8009 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8010
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8011 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8012 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8013 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8014 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8015 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8016
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8017 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8018 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8019 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8020 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8021
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8022 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8023 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8024 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8025 mismatch.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8026
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8027 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8028
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8029 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8030 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8031
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8032 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8033 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8034 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8035 removed from the label.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8036
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8037 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8038 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8039
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8040 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8041 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8042
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8043 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8044 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8045 expressions.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8046
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8047 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8048
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8049 ** New/deleted modes and packages
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8050
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8051 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8052 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8053
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8054 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8055 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8056 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8057
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8058 *** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8059 changes with a special face.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8060
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8061 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8062 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8063 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
8064
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8065 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8066
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8067 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8068 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8069 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8070 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8071 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8072
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8073 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8074 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8075 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8076
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8077 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8078 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8079 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8080 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8081 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8082 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8083 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8084 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8085 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8086
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8087 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8088 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8089 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8090 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8091 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8092 program.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8093
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8094 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8095 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8096 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8097 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8098 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8099 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8100
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8101 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8102 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8103 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8104 was not documented clearly before.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8105
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8106 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8107 This includes Tetris and Snake.
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
8108
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8109 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8110
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8111 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8112 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8113 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8114 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8115
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8116 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8117 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8118 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8119
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8120 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8121
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8122 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8123 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8124
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8125 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8126 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8127 integers.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8128
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8129 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8130 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8131 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8132 file names and attributes are returned.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8133
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8134 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8135 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
35680
1a6073992224 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35665
diff changeset
8136 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8137 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8138 returns the result.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8139
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8140 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8141 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8142
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8143 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8144
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8145 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8146 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8147 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8148 optionally.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8149
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8150 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8151 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8152
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8153 **
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8154 The new function process-running-child-p
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8155 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8156 terminal to its own child process.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8157
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8158 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8159 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8160 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8161 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8162
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8163 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8164 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8165
42974
b5c45e2ad1ae Fix typo.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 42958
diff changeset
8166 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8167 :included is an alias for :visible.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8168
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8169 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8170 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8171 to move or copy menu entries.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8172
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8173 ** Multibyte editing changes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8174
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8175 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8176 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8177 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8178 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8179 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8180 (setq char (sref str idx)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8181 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8182 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8183
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8184 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8185 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8186 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8187
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8188 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8189 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8190 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8191
35680
1a6073992224 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35665
diff changeset
8192 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8193
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8194 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8195 across the boundary.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8196
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8197 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8198 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8199 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8200 contains 8-bit characters.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8201 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8202 contains invalid characters.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8203
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8204 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8205 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8206 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8207 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8208 way.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8209
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8210 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8211 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8212 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8213 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8214
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8215 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8216 compose Thai characters in a string.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8217
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8218 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8219 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8220 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8221 menus should always use the third argument.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8222
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8223 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8224 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8225 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8226 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8227
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8228 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8229 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8230 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8231 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8232
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8233 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8234 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8235 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8236 echo area contents.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8237
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8238 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8239
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8240 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8241 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8242 requested feature cannot be loaded.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8243
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8244 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8245 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8246 means to clear out that attribute.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8247
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8248 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8249 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8250
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8251 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8252 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8253 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8254 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8255
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8256 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8257 the gap of the current buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8258
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8259 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8260 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8261 current buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8262
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8263 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8264 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8265 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8266 it back in after any modifications have been made.
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
8267
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8268 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8269
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8270 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8271 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8272 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8273 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8274 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8275
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8276 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8277 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8278 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8279 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8280 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8281
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8282 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8283 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8284 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8285
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8286 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8287 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8288 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8289 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8290 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8291 results.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8292
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8293 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8294 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8295 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8296 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
8297
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8298 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8299
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8300 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8301 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8302 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8303 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8304
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8305 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8306 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8307 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8308 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8309 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8310 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8311 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8312 region.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8313
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8314 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8315 selective undo.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8316
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8317 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8318 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8319 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8320 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8321 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8322
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8323 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8324 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8325 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8326 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8327
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8328 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8329 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8330 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8331 something that most users not do.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8332
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8333 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8334 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8335 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8336 applications.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8337
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8338 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8339 pasting operations.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8340
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8341 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8342 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8343 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8344 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8345 `ps-printer-name'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8346
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8347 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8348 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8349 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8350 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8351 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8352 hits a new word.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8353
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8354 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8355 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8356 to be confused by TeX commands.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8357
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8358 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8359 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8360 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8361 of various alternative replacements and actions.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8362
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8363 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8364 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8365 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8366 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8367 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8368
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8369 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8370 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8371
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8372 ** Changes in input method usage.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8373
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8374 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8375 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8376 respectively.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8377
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8378 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8379
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8380 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8381 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8382
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8383 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8384 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8385
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8386 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8387
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8388 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8389
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8390 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8391 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8392
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8393 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8394 given in the following case:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8395 o When you are using a complex input method.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8396 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8397
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8398 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8399 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8400 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8401 setting it to t is helpful.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8402
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8403 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8404
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8405 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8406 keys:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8407 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8408 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8409 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8410 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8411 environment.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8412
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8413 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8414 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8415 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8416 get
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8417
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8418 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8419
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8420 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8421
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8422 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8423 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8424
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8425 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8426 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8427 its owner and group.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8428
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8429 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8430 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8431
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8432 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8433 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8434
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8435 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8436 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8437 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8438 by the left edge of the rectangle.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8439
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8440 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8441 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8442 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8443 for writing keyboard macros.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8444
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8445 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8446 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8447 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8448 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8449 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8450 info.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8451
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8452 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8453
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8454 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8455 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8456 contents only.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8457
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8458 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8459 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8460 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8461 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8462
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8463 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8464 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8465 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8466
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8467 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8468 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8469 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8470 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8471
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8472 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8473 failure if the command produces no output.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8474
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8475 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8476 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8477 the mouse.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8478
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8479 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8480 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8481 function and variable names.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8482
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8483 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8484 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8485 file-coding-system-alist.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8486
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8487 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8488 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8489 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8490 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8491 according to the current fontset.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8492
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8493 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8494
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8495 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8496 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8497 nonascii-insert-offset.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8498
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8499 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8500 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8501 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8502 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8503
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8504 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8505 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8506
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8507 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8508 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8509
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8510 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8511 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8512 command keys.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8513
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8514 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8515 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8516
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8517 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8518 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8519 all variables that have documentation.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8520
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8521 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8522 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8523 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8524 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8525 it should show; the default is 20.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8526
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8527 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8528 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8529 of your input.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8530
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8531 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8532 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8533 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8534 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8535 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8536 Newly added options are included as well.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8537
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8538 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8539 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8540 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8541
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8542 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8543 Customize menu.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8544
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8545 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8546 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8547
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8548 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8549 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8550 invoked.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8551
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8552 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8553 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8554 The default is 1.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8555
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8556 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8557 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8558 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8559 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8560 sensibly.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8561
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8562 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8563
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8564 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8565 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8566 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8567
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8568 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8569 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8570 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8571 every night.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8572
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8573 ** Desktop changes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8574
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8575 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8576 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8577
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8578 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8579 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8580
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8581 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8582 read and post multi-lingual articles.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8583
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8584 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8585 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8586 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8587 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8588 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8589 made invisible again.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8590
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8591 ** Mail reading and sending changes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8592
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8593 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8594 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8595 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8596 toggle.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8597
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8598 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8599 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8600 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8601 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8602 rmail-default-body-file.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8603
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8604 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8605 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8606 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8607
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8608 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8609 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8610 is evaluated to insert the signature.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8611
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8612 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8613 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8614 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8615 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8616 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8617 especially interested in trying feedmail.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8618
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8619 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8620 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8621 provided by feedmail are:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8622
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8623 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8624 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8625 there is also a queue for draft messages
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8626
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8627 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8628 be prompted for confirmation
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8629
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8630 **** does smart filling of address headers
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8631
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8632 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8633 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8634 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8635
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8636 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8637 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8638 /usr/lib/sendmail, and elisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8639 function for something else (10-20 lines of elisp)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8640
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8641 ** Dired changes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8642
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8643 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8644 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8645
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8646 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8647 run Dired on the directory name at point.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8648
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8649 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8650 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8651 for a specified regexp.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8652
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8653 ** VC Changes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8654
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8655 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8656 conveniently.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8657
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8658 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8659 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8660 Dired.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8661
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8662 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8663 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8664 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8665 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8666
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8667 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8668 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8669 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8670 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8671 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8672
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8673 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8674 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8675 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8676 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8677 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8678
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8679 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8680 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8681 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8682 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8683
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8684 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8685 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8686 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8687
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8688 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8689 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8690 session to resolve them.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8691
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8692 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8693 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8694 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8695 uses as well).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8696
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8697 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8698 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8699 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8700 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8701 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8702 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8703 using ediff.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8704
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8705 ** Changes in Font Lock
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8706
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8707 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8708 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8709 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8710 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8711 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8712
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8713 ** Frame name display changes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8714
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8715 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8716 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8717 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8718 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8719
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8720 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8721 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8722 menu.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8723
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8724 ** Comint (subshell) changes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8725
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8726 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8727 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8728 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8729
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8730 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8731
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8732 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8733 that is, the line after the last line you got.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8734 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8735
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8736 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8737 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8738 the following line.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8739
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8740 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8741 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8742 previously sent input.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8743
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8744 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8745 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8746 as the search string.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8747
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8748 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8749 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8750
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8751 ** C mode changes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8752
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8753 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8754 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8755 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8756 definition.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8757
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8758 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8759 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8760 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8761 style is still the default however.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8762
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8763 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8764
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8765 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8766 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8767 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8768
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8769 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8770 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8771
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8772 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8773 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8774
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8775 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8776 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8777
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8778 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8779 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8780
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8781 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8782 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8783 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8784 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8785
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8786 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8787
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8788 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8789 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8790 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8791
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8792 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8793 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8794 expanding dynamically.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8795
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8796 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8797 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8798
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8799 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8800 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8801 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8802 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8803
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8804 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8805
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8806 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8807
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8808 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8809 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8810 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8811 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8812 against the first word in the title.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8813
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8814 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8815 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8816 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8817 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8818 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8819 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8820
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8821 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8822 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8823 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8824 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8825
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8826 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8827
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8828 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8829 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8830 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8831 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8832 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8833 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8834
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8835 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8836 Editing group once the package is loaded.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8837
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8838 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8839 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
35680
1a6073992224 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35665
diff changeset
8840 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8841
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8842 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8843 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8844
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8845 ** Ispell changes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8846
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8847 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8848 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8849 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8850
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8851 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8852 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8853 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8854 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8855 include:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8856
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8857 o URLs are automatically skipped
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8858 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8859
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8860 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8861
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8862 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8863
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8864 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8865 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8866 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8867 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8868
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8869 *** New recursive parser.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8870
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8871 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8872 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8873 recursive parser scans the individual files.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8874
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8875 *** Parsing only part of a document.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8876
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8877 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8878 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8879 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8880
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8881 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8882
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8883 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8884
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8885 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8886
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8887 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8888
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8889 *** Using multiple selection buffers
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8890
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8891 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8892 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8893
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8894 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8895
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8896 *** References to external documents.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8897
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8898 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8899 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8900 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8901 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8902 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8903 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8904 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8905
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8906 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8907
35680
1a6073992224 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 35665
diff changeset
8908 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8909 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8910
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8911 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8912 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8913
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8914 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8915
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8916 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8917 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8918
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8919 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8920
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8921 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8922 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8923 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8924 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8925 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8926 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8927 more.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8928
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8929 *** Support for the varioref package
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8930
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8931 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8932
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8933 *** New hooks
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8934
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8935 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8936 and citations are created. These hooks are
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8937 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8938 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8939
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8940 *** Citations outside LaTeX
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8941
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8942 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8943 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8944
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8945 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8946
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8947 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8948 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8949 fontified, use
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8950
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8951 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8952
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8953 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8954 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8955 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8956 directories that contain the same file name.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8957
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8958 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8959 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8960 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8961 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8962 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8963 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8964 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8965 directory.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8966
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8967 ** New modes and packages
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8968
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8969 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8970 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8971 it, but some do not.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8972
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8973 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8974 code.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8975
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8976 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8977 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8978 around in a buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8979
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8980 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8981
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8982 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8983 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8984 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8985 established system of notation similar to Chess.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8986
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8987 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8988 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8989 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8990
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8991 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8992 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8993 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8994 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8995 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8996 the like.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8997
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8998 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
8999 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9000
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9001 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9002 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9003 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9004 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9005
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9006 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9007
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9008 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9009 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9010 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9011 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9012 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9013 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9014 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9015 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9016 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9017 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9018 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9019
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9020 Platform-specific modes:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9021
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9022 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9023 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9024 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9025 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9026 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9027 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9028 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9029 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9030 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
9031
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9032 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9033
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9034 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9035 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9036 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9037 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9038
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9039 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9040 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9041 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9042
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9043 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9044 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9045 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9046 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9047
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9048 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9049 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9050 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9051 environment.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9052
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9053 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9054 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9055 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9056 current input method for reading this one event.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9057
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9058 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9059 now control whether to output certain characters as
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9060 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9061 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9062 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9063 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
9064
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9065 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9066
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9067 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9068 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9069
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9070 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9071 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9072 always increases point by 1.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9073
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9074 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9075 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9076
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9077 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9078
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9079 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9080 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9081 default value changed. For example,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9082
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9083 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9084 :type 'integer
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9085 :group 'foo
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9086 :version "20.3")
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9087
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9088 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9089 :version "20.3")
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9090
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9091 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9092 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9093 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9094 `:version' in the top level group.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9095
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9096 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9097
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9098 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9099 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9100
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9101 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9102 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9103 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9104 to themselves.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9105
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9106 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9107 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9108 values whatever.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9109
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9110 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9111 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9112 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9113
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9114 ** Frame-local variables.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9115
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9116 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9117 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9118 local bindings for that variable.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9119
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9120 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9121 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9122 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9123 parameter name.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9124
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9125 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9126 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9127 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9128 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9129
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9130 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9131 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9132 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9133 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9134
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9135 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9136 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9137 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9138 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9139 See the documentation in sregex.el.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9140
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9141 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9142 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9143 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9144 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9145
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9146 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9147 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9148
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9149 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9150 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9151 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9152
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9153 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9154 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9155 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9156 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9157
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9158 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9159 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9160 empty input.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9161
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9162 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9163 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9164 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9165 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9166 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9167
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9168 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9169 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9170 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9171 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9172
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9173 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9174 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9175 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9176 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9177 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9178
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9179 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9180 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9181 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9182 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9183
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9184 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9185 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9186 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9187
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9188 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9189 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9190 was directed to display this buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9191
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9192 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9193 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9194 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9195 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9196 set-window-configuration.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9197
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9198 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9199 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9200 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9201 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9202
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9203 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9204 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9205 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9206
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9207 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9208 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9209 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9210
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9211 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9212 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9213
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9214 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9215 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9216
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9217 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9218 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9219 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9220
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9221 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9222 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9223 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9224 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9225
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9226 ** Menu changes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9227
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9228 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9229 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9230 better supported.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9231
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9232 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9233 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9234 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9235 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9236 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9237
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9238 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9239
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9240 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9241 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9242 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9243 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9244
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9245 The format is:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9246 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9247 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9248 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9249 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9250 The supported properties include
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9251
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9252 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9253 item is enabled.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9254 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9255 item should appear in the menu.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9256 :filter FILTER-FN
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9257 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9258 which will be REAL-BINDING.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9259 It should return a binding to use instead.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9260 :keys DESCRIPTION
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9261 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
35862
9604ca6b3728 More typos from Juanma Barranquero <lektu@uol.com.br>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35847
diff changeset
9262 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9263 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9264 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9265 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9266 keyboard binding.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9267 :key-sequence nil
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9268 This means that the command normally has no
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9269 keyboard equivalent.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9270 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9271 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9272 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9273 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9274 value says whether this button is currently selected.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9275
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9276 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9277 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9278
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9279 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9280
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9281 ** New event types
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9282
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9283 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9284 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9285 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9286 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9287
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9288 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9289
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9290 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9291 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9292 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9293 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9294 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9295 forward, away from the user.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9296
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9297 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9298
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9299 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9300 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9301 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9302 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9303 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9304
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9305 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9306
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9307 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9308 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9309 that were dragged and dropped.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9310
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9311 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9312
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9313 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9314
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9315 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9316 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9317 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9318
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9319 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9320 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9321 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9322
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9323 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9324 in Emacs 19 and before.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9325
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9326 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9327 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9328
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9329 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9330 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9331 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9332 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9333
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9334 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9335 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9336 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9337 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9338 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9339
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9340 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9341 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9342 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9343 consistent with the new representation.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9344
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9345 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9346 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9347 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9348 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9349
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9350 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9351 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9352 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9353
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9354 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9355 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9356 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9357
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9358 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9359 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9360 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9361
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9362 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9363 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9364
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9365 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9366 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9367
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9368 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9369 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9370 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9371 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9372
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9373 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9374 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9375
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9376 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9377 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9378 buffer or string being searched.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9379
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9380 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9381 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9382 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9383 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9384 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9385 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9386 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9387
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9388 *** Structure of coding system changed.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9389
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9390 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9391 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9392 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9393 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9394 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9395 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9396 define-coding-system-alias.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9397
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9398 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9399 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9400 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9401 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9402 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9403 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9404 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9405 `iso-8859-1'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9406
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9407 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9408 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9409 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9410 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9411
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9412 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9413 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9414 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9415 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9416
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9417 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9418 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9419 This function requires a user interaction.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9420
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9421 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9422 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9423 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9424 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9425 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9426 select-safe-coding-system.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9427
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9428 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9429 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9430 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9431 was done.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9432
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9433 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9434 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9435 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9436
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9437 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9438 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9439 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9440 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9441
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9442 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9443 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9444 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9445 converted.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9446
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9447 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9448 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9449
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9450 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9451 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9452 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9453 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9454 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9455 range of characters.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9456
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9457 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9458 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9459
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9460 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9461 in the current buffer at position POS.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9462
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9463 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9464 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9465 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9466 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9467 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9468 binding input-method-function to nil.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9469
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9470 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9471 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9472 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9473 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9474 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9475
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9476 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9477 subsequent events of a key sequence.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9478
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9479 *** You can customize any language environment by using
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9480 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9481
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9482 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9483 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9484 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9485 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9486 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
9487
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9488 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9489
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9490 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9491 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9492 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9493 tree structure.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9494
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9495 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9496 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9497
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9498 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9499 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9500 in your .emacs file.)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9501
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9502 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9503 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9504
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9505 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9506 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9507
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9508 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9509 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9510 kills the region.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9511
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9512 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9513 delete the character before point, as usual.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9514
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9515 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9516 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9517 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9518
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9519 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9520 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9521 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9522 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9523 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9524 past.)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9525
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9526 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9527 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9528 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9529 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9530 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9531
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9532 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9533 and is an alias for it.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9534
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9535 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9536 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9537
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9538 ** Scrolling changes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9539
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9540 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9541 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9542
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9543 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9544 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9545 where it started.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9546
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9547 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9548 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9549 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9550 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9551
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9552 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9553 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9554 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9555 recenters the window.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9556
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9557 ** International character set support (MULE)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9558
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9559 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9560 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9561 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9562 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9563 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9564 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9565
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9566 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9567 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9568 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9569 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9570 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9571
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9572 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9573 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9574 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9575 language, to make it possible to type them.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9576
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9577 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9578 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9579
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9580 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9581 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9582
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9583 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9584
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9585 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9586
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9587 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9588 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9589 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9590 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9591 characters for their work until they want to change.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9592
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9593 *** Input methods
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9594
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9595 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9596 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9597 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9598 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9599 support several input methods.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9600
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9601 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9602 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9603 work.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9604
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9605 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9606 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9607 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9608 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9609 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9610 letter.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9611
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9612 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9613 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9614 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9615 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9616 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9617
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9618 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9619 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9620 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9621 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9622
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9623 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9624 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9625 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9626 the first guess is wrong.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9627
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9628 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9629 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9630
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9631 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9632 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9633 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9634 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9635
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9636 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9637 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9638 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9639 translate automatically to and from either one.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9640
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9641 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9642
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9643 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9644 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9645 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9646 what you want.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9647
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9648 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9649 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9650 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9651 multibyte characters in that buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9652
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9653 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9654 character conversion as well.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9655
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9656 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9657
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9658 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9659 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9660 requires using many fonts.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9661
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9662 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9663 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9664
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9665 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9666 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9667 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9668 you would use a font.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9669
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9670 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9671 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9672 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9673
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9674 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9675 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
41055
ff0394a304bd Remove the description of variabel `highlight-wrong-size-font'.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents: 40973
diff changeset
9676 characters).
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9677
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9678 *** Defining fontsets.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9679
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9680 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9681 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9682 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9683
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9684 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9685 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9686 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9687 standard fontset are created automatically.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9688
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9689 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9690 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9691 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9692 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9693 name is `fontset-startup'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9694
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9695 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9696 The resource value should have this form:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9697 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9698 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9699 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9700 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9701 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9702 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9703 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
35863
534be6e166a6 Yet another bunch of typo fizes from Juanma Barranquero <lektu@uol.com.br>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35862
diff changeset
9704 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
534be6e166a6 Yet another bunch of typo fizes from Juanma Barranquero <lektu@uol.com.br>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35862
diff changeset
9705 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9706
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9707 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9708 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9709 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9710
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9711 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9712 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9713 following resource,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9714 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9715 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9716 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9717 Here is the substitution rule:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9718 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9719 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9720 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9721 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9722 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9723
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9724 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9725 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9726 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9727
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9728 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9729 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9730 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9731 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9732 fontsets.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9733
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9734 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9735 defaults for a particular choice of language.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9736
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9737 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9738 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9739 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9740 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9741 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9742 system for new files that you create.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9743
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9744 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9745 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9746 whole Emacs session.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9747
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9748 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9749 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9750 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9751
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9752 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9753 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9754 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9755 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9756 coding systems that Emacs supports.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9757
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9758 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9759 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9760 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9761 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9762 is used for *the immediately following command*.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9763
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9764 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9765 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9766
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9767 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9768 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9769
47283
0f65e6f1d100 Fix spacing.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 47201
diff changeset
9770 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9771 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9772
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9773 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9774 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9775 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9776 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9777 of the file.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9778
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9779 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9780 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9781 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9782 translated into that character code.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9783
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9784 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9785 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9786
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9787 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9788
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9789 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9790 the coding system for keyboard input.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9791
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9792 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9793 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9794 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9795
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9796 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9797
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9798 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9799 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9800 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9801 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9802 designed to work with terminals.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9803
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9804 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9805 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9806 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9807 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9808 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9809 in the corresponding buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9810
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9811 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9812
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9813 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9814 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9815 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9816
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9817 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9818 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9819 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9820 want to use.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9821
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9822 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9823 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9824
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9825 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9826 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9827 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9828 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9829
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9830 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9831 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9832 related information.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9833
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9834 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9835 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9836 scripts.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9837
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9838 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9839 information about the support for a particular language.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9840 You specify the language as an argument.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9841
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9842 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9843 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9844 first dash.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9845
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9846 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9847 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9848 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9849 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9850
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9851 A alternativnyj (Russian)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9852 B big5 (Chinese)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9853 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9854 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9855 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9856 E euc-japan (Japanese)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9857 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9858 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9859 K euc-korea (Korean)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9860 R koi8 (Russian)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9861 Q tibetan
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9862 S shift_jis (Japanese)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9863 T lao
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9864 T tis620 (Thai)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9865 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9866 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9867 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9868 v viqr (Vietnamese)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9869 z hz (Chinese)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9870
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9871 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9872 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9873 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9874 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9875
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9876 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9877 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9878
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9879 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9880 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9881 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9882 Rmail files themselves.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9883
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9884 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9885 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9886
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9887 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9888 for sending mail:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9889
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9890 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9891 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9892 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9893 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9894 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9895
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9896 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9897 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9898 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9899 translations.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9900
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9901 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9902 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9903 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9904 without any conversion.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9905
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9906 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9907 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9908 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9909 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9910
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9911 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9912 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9913
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9914 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9915 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9916
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9917 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9918 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9919
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9920 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9921 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9922 in the buffer before point.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9923
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9924 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9925 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9926 you are using.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9927
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9928 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9929 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9930
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9931 ** File locking works with NFS now.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9932
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9933 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9934 in the same directory as FILENAME.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9935
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9936 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9937 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9938 can become a bottleneck.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9939
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9940 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9941 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9942 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9943 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9944 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9945 so useful that the change is worth while.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9946
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9947 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9948 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9949 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9950 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9951
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9952 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9953 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9954 show-paren-mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9955
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9956 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9957 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9958 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9959
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9960 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9961 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9962 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9963
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9964 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9965 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9966 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9967
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9968 ** Changes in View mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9969
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9970 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9971 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9972
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9973 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9974 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9975
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9976 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9977 previous state.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9978
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9979 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9980 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9981
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9982 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9983 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9984 not just the selected window.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9985
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9986 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9987 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9988 turns View mode on or off.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9989
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9990 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9991 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9992 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9993
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9994 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9995 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9996
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9997 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9998 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
9999 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10000 which version to compare with.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10001
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10002 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10003 blocks if a match is inside the block.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10004
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10005 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10006 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10007 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10008 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10009
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10010 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10011 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10012 blocks, all of them or none.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10013
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10014 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10015 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10016 confirmation first.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10017
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10018 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10019 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10020 However, the mode will not be changed if
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10021 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10022 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10023 not suitable for ordinary files, or
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10024 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10025
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10026 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10027
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10028 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10029 these commands do not change the major mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10030
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10031 ** M-x occur changes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10032
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10033 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10034 it performs a case-sensitive search.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10035
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10036 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10037 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10038 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10039
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10040 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10041 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10042 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10043 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10044 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10045
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10046 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10047 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10048 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10049 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10050
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10051 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10052 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10053 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10054
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10055 ** Outline mode changes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10056
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10057 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10058
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10059 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10060
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10061 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10062 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10063 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10064 was already active.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10065
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10066 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10067 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10068 get confused by it.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10069
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10070 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10071 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10072
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10073 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10074
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10075 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10076 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10077 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10078 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10079
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10080 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10081 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10082 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10083
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10084 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10085 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10086 values.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10087
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10088 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10089 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10090 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10091 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10092
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10093 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10094 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10095 can be. The default value is 30.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10096
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10097 ** Changes in Mail mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10098
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10099 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10100 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10101 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10102 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10103 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10104 behavior.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10105
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10106 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10107 compose-mail-other-frame.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10108
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10109 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10110 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10111 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10112 buffer that shows the original message.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10113
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10114 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10115 with separator lines around the contents.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10116
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10117 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10118 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10119 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10120 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10121
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10122 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10123
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10124 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10125 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10126 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10127 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10128
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10129 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10130 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10131 /etc/passwd.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10132
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10133 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10134 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10135 /etc/passwd.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10136
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10137 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10138 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10139 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10140 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10141
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10142 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10143 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10144 be taken to be magic.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10145
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10146 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10147 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10148 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10149
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10150 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10151 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10152
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10153 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10154 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10155
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10156 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10157
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10158 new key dired.el binding old key
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10159 ------- ---------------- -------
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10160 * c dired-change-marks c
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10161 * m dired-mark m
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10162 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10163 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10164 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10165 * u dired-unmark u
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10166 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
40526
b466f4f946a7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40493
diff changeset
10167 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10168 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10169 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10170 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10171 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10172
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10173 ** Rmail changes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10174
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10175 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10176 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10177 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10178 each time you run it.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10179
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10180 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10181 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10182
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10183 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10184 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10185 means to move in the opposite direction.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10186
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10187 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10188 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10189
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10190 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10191 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10192 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10193 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10194 for output.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10195
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10196 ** Gnus changes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10197
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10198 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10199
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10200 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10201 Gnus.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10202
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10203 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10204 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10205
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10206 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10207 article mode line.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10208
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10209 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10210
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10211 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10212
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10213 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10214
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10215 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10216 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10217 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10218
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10219 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10220
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10221 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10222
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10223 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10224 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10225
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10226 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10227 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10228 used to pick articles.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10229
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10230 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10231 another have been added.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10232
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10233 `M-x gnus-change-server'
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10234
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10235 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10236 generating lines in buffers.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10237
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10238 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
40526
b466f4f946a7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40493
diff changeset
10239 `C-M-_'.
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10240
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10241 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10242
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10243 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10244
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10245 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10246
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10247 *** Scores can be decayed.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10248
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10249 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10250
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10251 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10252 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10253
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10254 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10255 the native server.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10256
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10257 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10258
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10259 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
40526
b466f4f946a7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40493
diff changeset
10260 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10261
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10262 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10263
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10264 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10265 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10266
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10267 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10268 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10269
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10270 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10271 a group.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10272
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10273 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10274 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10275
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10276 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10277
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10278 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10279
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10280 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10281
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10282 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10283
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10284 Use the `Y c' command.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10285
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10286 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10287
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10288 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10289
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10290 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10291
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10292 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10293 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10294
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10295 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10296
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10297 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10298
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10299 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10300 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10301
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10302 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10303
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10304 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10305 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10306 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10307 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10308 this issue.)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10309
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10310 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10311 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10312 particular news group. This can be done by:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10313
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10314 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10315
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10316 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10317 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10318 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10319 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10320 for reading and posting).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10321
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10322 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10323 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10324 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10325 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10326 there.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10327
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10328 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10329 default. Here are some of these default settings:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10330
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10331 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10332 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10333 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10334 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10335 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10336
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10337 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10338 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10339
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10340 ** CC mode changes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10341
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10342 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10343 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10344 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10345 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10346 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10347 loaded.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10348
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10349 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10350 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10351 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10352 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10353 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10354 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10355
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10356 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10357 of the current buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10358
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10359 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10360 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10361 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10362
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10363 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10364 style that the Python developers like.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10365
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10366 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10367 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10368 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10369
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10370 ** VC Changes [new]
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10371
36908
365eecf7e7d7 Added a note about new support for the Baha'i calendar.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 36885
diff changeset
10372 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10373 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10374 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10375
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10376 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10377 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10378 developers.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10379
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10380 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10381 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10382
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10383 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10384 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10385 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10386 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10387
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10388 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10389 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10390
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10391 ** Calendar changes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10392
36908
365eecf7e7d7 Added a note about new support for the Baha'i calendar.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 36885
diff changeset
10393 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
365eecf7e7d7 Added a note about new support for the Baha'i calendar.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 36885
diff changeset
10394 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
365eecf7e7d7 Added a note about new support for the Baha'i calendar.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 36885
diff changeset
10395 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
365eecf7e7d7 Added a note about new support for the Baha'i calendar.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 36885
diff changeset
10396 following/previous years.
365eecf7e7d7 Added a note about new support for the Baha'i calendar.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 36885
diff changeset
10397
365eecf7e7d7 Added a note about new support for the Baha'i calendar.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 36885
diff changeset
10398 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
365eecf7e7d7 Added a note about new support for the Baha'i calendar.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 36885
diff changeset
10399 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
365eecf7e7d7 Added a note about new support for the Baha'i calendar.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 36885
diff changeset
10400 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
365eecf7e7d7 Added a note about new support for the Baha'i calendar.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 36885
diff changeset
10401 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
365eecf7e7d7 Added a note about new support for the Baha'i calendar.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 36885
diff changeset
10402 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
365eecf7e7d7 Added a note about new support for the Baha'i calendar.
John Wiegley <johnw@newartisans.com>
parents: 36885
diff changeset
10403 supposed attribute of God.
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10404
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10405 ** ps-print changes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10406
37289
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10407 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10408 layout.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10409
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10410 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10411
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10412 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10413 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10414 printer system has this behavior, set variable
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10415 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10416
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10417 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10418 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
37375
612c8df1b6a5 Fix a typo.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37365
diff changeset
10419 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
37289
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10420
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10421 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10422 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10423
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10424 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10425 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10426 printing for your printer.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10427
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10428 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10429 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10430
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10431 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10432 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10433
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10434 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10435 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10436 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10437 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10438 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10439 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10440 The default value is nil.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10441
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10442 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10443 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10444
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10445 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10446 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10447 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10448 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10449 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10450 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10451 color). The default is 0 ("black").
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10452
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10453 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10454 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10455
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10456 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10457 The default is 0 ("black").
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10458
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10459 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10460 The default is 0 ("black").
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10461
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10462 border-width Specify the border width.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10463 The default is 0.4.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10464
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10465 Any other property is ignored.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10466
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10467 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10468 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10469 documentation).
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10470
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10471 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10472 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10473 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10474 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10475 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10476 controlling headers.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10477
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10478 *** Color management (subgroup)
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10479
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10480 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10481 color.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10482
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10483 *** Face Management (subgroup)
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10484
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10485 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10486 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10487 background should be used. Valid values are:
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10488
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10489 t always use face background color.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10490 nil never use face background color.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10491 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10492
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10493 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10494
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10495 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10496 sheet of paper.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10497
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10498 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10499 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10500
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10501 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10502 each page.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10503
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10504 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10505 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10506 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10507
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10508 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10509 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10510 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10511
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10512 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10513 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10514 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10515
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10516 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10517 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10518 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10519
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10520 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10521 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10522 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10523
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10524 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10525
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10526 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10527
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10528 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10529 RGB color.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10530
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10531 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10532 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10533 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10534
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10535 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10536 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10537 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10538 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10539 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10540 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10541 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10542 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10543 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10544 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10545 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10546 10 + 10 +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10547 11 + 11 +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10548 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10549 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10550 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10551 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10552 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10553 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10554 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10555 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10556 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10557 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10558 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10559 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10560 22 + 22 +
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10561 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10562
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10563 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10564
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10565
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10566 *** Printer management (subgroup)
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10567
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10568 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10569 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10570 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10571 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10572 to "-P".
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10573
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10574 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10575 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10576 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10577
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10578 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10579 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10580 do so.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10581
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10582 *** Page settings (subgroup)
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10583
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10584 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10585 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10586 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10587 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10588 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10589 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10590 `setpagedevice'.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10591
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10592 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10593 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10594 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10595
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10596 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10597 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10598 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10599 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10600 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10601 its TO, are ignored.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10602
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10603 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10604 pages. Valid values are:
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10605
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10606 nil print all pages.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10607
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10608 `even-page' print only even pages.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10609
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10610 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10611
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10612 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10613 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10614 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10615 print only the even sheet of paper.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10616
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10617 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10618 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10619 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10620 only the odd sheet of paper.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10621
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10622 Any other value is treated as nil.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10623
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10624 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10625 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10626 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10627
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10628 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10629
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10630 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10631 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10632
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10633 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10634 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10635 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10636 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10637 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10638 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10639 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10640
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10641 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10642 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10643 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10644 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10645 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10646 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10647 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10648
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10649 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10650
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10651 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10652 messages should be sent.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10653
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10654 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10655 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10656 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10657
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10658 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10659
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10660 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10661 points for line numbers.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10662
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10663 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10664 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10665
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10666 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10667 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10668 to 2, the printing will look like:
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10669
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10670 1 one line
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10671 one line
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10672 3 one line
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10673 one line
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10674 5 one line
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10675 one line
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10676 ...
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10677
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10678 Valid values are:
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10679
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10680 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10681 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10682 is used.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10683
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10684 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10685 zebra stripe is to be printed.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10686
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10687 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10688
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10689 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10690 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10691 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10692 3, the output will look like:
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10693
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10694 one line
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10695 one line
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10696 3 one line
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10697 one line
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10698 one line
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10699 6 one line
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10700 one line
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10701 one line
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10702 9 one line
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10703 one line
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10704 ...
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10705
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10706 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10707 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10708
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10709 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10710 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10711 `ps-font-size').
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10712
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10713 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10714 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10715 `ps-font-size').
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10716
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10717 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10718
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10719 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
a1af2574e64b Ps-print news.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 37230
diff changeset
10720 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10721
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10722 ** hideshow changes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10723
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10724 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10725 C++, ; for lisp).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10726
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10727 *** Support for java-mode added.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10728
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10729 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10730 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10731
35862
9604ca6b3728 More typos from Juanma Barranquero <lektu@uol.com.br>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 35847
diff changeset
10732 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10733 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10734 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10735
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10736 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10737 robust and a lot faster.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10738
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10739 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10740
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10741 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10742 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10743 documentation for more details.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10744
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10745 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10746
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10747 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10748 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10749 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10750 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10751 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10752
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10753 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10754 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10755 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10756 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10757
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10758 ** Font Lock mode
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10759
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10760 *** Custom support
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10761
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10762 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10763 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10764 faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new custom
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10765 group font-lock-highlighting-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10766 your ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10767 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10768
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10769 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10770
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10771 *** Maximum decoration
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10772
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10773 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10774 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10775 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10776 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10777 to get the old behavior.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10778
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10779 *** New support
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10780
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10781 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10782
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10783 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10784 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10785
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10786 *** Configurable support
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10787
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10788 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10789 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10790 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10791 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10792 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10793 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10794 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10795
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10796 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10797 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10798 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10799
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10800 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10801
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10802 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10803 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10804 for any mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10805
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10806 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10807
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10808 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10809
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10810 in your ~/.emacs.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10811
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10812 *** New faces
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10813
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10814 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10815 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10816 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10817 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10818
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10819 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10820
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10821 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10822 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10823 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10824
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10825 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10826
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10827 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10828 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10829 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10830 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10831 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10832 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
46989
eeab5bdaffa2 Fix typos.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46962
diff changeset
10833 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10834
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10835 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10836 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10837 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10838 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10839 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10840 the command M-g M-g (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10841
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10842 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10843
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10844 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10845 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10846 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10847 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10848
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10849 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10850 settings.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10851
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10852 ** Ada mode changes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10853
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10854 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10855 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10856 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10857 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10858 stubs.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10859
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10860 *** There are two new commands:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10861 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10862 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10863
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10864 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10865 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10866 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10867
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10868 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10869 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10870 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10871
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10872 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10873 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10874 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10875 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10876
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10877 ** Scheme mode changes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10878
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10879 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10880 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10881 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10882 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10883 have any effect.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10884
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10885 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10886 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10887 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10888 variables as buffer-local variables.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10889
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10890 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10891 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10892
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10893 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10894
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10895 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10896 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10897 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10898 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10899
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10900 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10901 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10902 buffer in Emacs.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10903
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10904 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10905 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10906 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10907 option takes precedence.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10908
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10909 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10910 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10911 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10912
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10913 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10914 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10915 the current defun.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10916
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10917 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10918 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10919
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10920 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10921 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10922 necessary).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10923
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10924 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10925 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10926 these register values no longer become completely useless.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10927 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10928 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10929 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10930
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10931 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10932 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10933 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10934 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10935
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10936 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10937 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10938 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10939 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10940 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10941
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10942 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10943 since it applies only to the current frame.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10944
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10945 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10946 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10947 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10948
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10949 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10950 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10951 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10952 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10953 instead of just the file you are editing.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10954
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10955 ** RefTeX mode
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10956
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10957 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10958 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10959 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10960 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10961 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10962
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10963 C-c ( reftex-label
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10964 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10965 knows which kind of label is needed.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10966
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10967 C-c ) reftex-reference
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10968 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10969 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10970
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10971 C-c [ reftex-citation
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10972 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10973 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10974
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10975 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10976 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10977
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10978 C-c = reftex-toc
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10979 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10980 can quickly jump to every section.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10981
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10982 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10983 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10984 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10985 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10986 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10987
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10988 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10989
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10990 *** Info documentation is now available.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10991
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10992 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10993 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10994
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10995 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10996 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10997
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10998 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
10999 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11000
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11001 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11002 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11003 appropriate functions.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11004
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11005 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
40526
b466f4f946a7 *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 40493
diff changeset
11006 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11007
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11008 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11009 been cleaned.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11010
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11011 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11012 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11013
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11014 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11015 shall be delimited.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11016
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11017 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11018 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11019 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11020
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11021 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11022 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11023 prefixed with `ALT'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11024
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11025 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11026 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11027 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11028 documentation).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11029
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11030 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11031 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11032 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11033
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11034 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11035 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11036
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11037 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11038 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11039 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11040
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11041 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11042
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11043 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11044
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11045 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11046 from alien sources.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11047
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11048 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11049 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11050 crossref entries.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11051
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11052 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11053 region.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11054
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11055 *** Added support for imenu.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11056
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11057 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11058 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11059 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11060 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11061
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11062 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11063 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11064
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11065 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11066
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11067 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11068
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11069 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11070 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11071 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11072 as an argument.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11073
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11074 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11075 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11076
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11077 ** browse-url changes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11078
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11079 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11080 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11081 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11082 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11083 customization variables.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11084
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11085 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11086
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11087 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11088 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11089 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11090
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11091 ** Changes in Ediff
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11092
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11093 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11094 pops up the Info file for this command.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11095
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11096 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11097 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11098 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11099 directories).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11100
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11101 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11102 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11103 files in the same directory.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11104
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11105 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11106 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11107 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11108
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11109 ** Changes in Viper
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11110
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11111 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11112 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11113 instead of vip-.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11114 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11115 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11116 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11117 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11118 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11119 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11120 color when Viper is in insert state.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11121 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11122 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11123 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11124
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11125 ** Etags changes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11126
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11127 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11128 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11129 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11130 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11131 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11132
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11133 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11134
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11135 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11136 constructs are tagged. Files are recognised by the extension .java.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11137
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11138 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11139 recognised by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11140 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11141
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11142 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11143 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11144 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11145 methods and protocols.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11146
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11147 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognised by the extension
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11148 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11149 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11150 paragraph name.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11151
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11152 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11153 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11154 at least M times and as many as N times.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11155
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11156 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11157 in files has changed slightly.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11158
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11159 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11160 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11161 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11162 with old time-stamp-format values.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11163
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11164 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11165 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11166 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11167 reasons.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11168
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11169 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11170 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11171 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11172 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11173 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11174 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11175
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11176 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11177 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11178 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11179
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11180 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11181 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11182 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11183 recommended now will continue to work then.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11184
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11185 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11186 details.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11187
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11188 ** There are some additional major modes:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11189
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11190 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11191 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11192 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11193
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11194 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11195 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11196 into Emacs.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11197
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11198 ** New Lisp packages include:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11199
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11200 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11201
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11202 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11203 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11204
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11205 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11206
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11207 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11208 in shell buffers.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11209
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11210 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11211 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11212 and `elint-defun'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11213
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11214 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11215 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11216 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11217 strings or comments.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11218
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11219 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11220 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11221 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11222 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11223 at these points.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11224
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11225 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11226 can visit them by short forms of their names.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11227
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11228 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11229 Emacs Lisp function at point.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11230
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11231 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11232
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11233 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11234 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11235
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11236 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11237
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11238 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11239
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11240 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11241
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11242 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11243 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11244
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11245 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11246 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11247 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11248 original place after inserting the copy.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11249
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11250 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11251 on the buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11252
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11253 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11254 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11255 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11256
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11257 Enable mouse-drag with:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11258 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11259 -or-
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11260 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11261
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11262 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11263 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11264
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11265 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11266 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11267
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11268 *** ogonek
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11269
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11270 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11271 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11272 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11273 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11274 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11275 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11276 instance) and vice versa.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11277
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11278 To use this package load it using
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11279 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11280 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11281 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11282 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11283 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11284 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11285
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11286 *** Interface to ph.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11287
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11288 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11289
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11290 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11291 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11292 these servers.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11293
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11294 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11295
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11296 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11297 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11298 while the real cursor does not move.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11299
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11300 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11301 for visiting your favorite web sites.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11302
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11303 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11304 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11305
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11306 ** movemail change
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11307
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11308 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11309 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11310 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11311 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11312
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11313 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
11314
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11315 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11316
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11317 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11318
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11319 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11320 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11321 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11322 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11323 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11324
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11325 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11326 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11327 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11328 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11329 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11330 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
11331
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11332 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11333
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11334 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11335 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11336 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11337 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11338
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11339 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11340 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11341
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11342 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11343 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11344 "win".
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11345
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11346 ** Basic Lisp changes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11347
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11348 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11349 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11350
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11351 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11352 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11353 or by the user.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11354
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11355 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11356
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11357 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11358
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11359 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11360 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11361
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11362 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11363 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11364 its argument.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11365
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11366 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11367
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11368 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11369
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11370 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11371
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11372 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11373 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11374 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11375 `format' function.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11376
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11377 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11378 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11379 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11380
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11381 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11382 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11383 adding one of these suffixes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11384
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11385 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11386 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11387 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11388
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11389 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11390 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11391
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11392 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11393
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11394 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11395 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11396
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11397 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11398 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11399
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11400 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11401
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11402 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11403 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11404
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11405 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11406 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11407 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11408 works using `save-current-buffer'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11409
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11410 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11411 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11412 of the last form.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11413
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11414 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11415 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11416 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11417 as the last form.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11418
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11419 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11420 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11421 matches.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11422
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11423 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11424
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11425 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11426 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11427 Then it returns that string.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11428
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11429 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11430
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11431 (with-output-to-string
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11432 (princ "The buffer is ")
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11433 (princ (buffer-name)))
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11434
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11435 returns "The buffer is foo".
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11436
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11437 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11438 is non-nil.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11439
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11440 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11441 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11442 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11443
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11444 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11445 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11446
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11447 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11448 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11449 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11450 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11451 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11452 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11453
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11454 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11455 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11456 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11457 characters".
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11458
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11459 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11460 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11461 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11462 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11463 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11464
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11465 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11466 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11467 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11468 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11469
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11470 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11471 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11472
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11473 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11474
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11475 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11476 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11477 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11478 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11479 guaranteed.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11480
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11481 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11482 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11483 character).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11484
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11485 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11486
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11487 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11488 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11489 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11490 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11491 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11492
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11493 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11494
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11495 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11496 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11497 more than the number of characters.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11498
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11499 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11500 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11501 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11502 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11503 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11504 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11505
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11506 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11507 and returns a string containing those characters.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11508
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11509 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11510 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11511 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11512 character, sref signals an error.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11513
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11514 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11515 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11516 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11517
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11518 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11519 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11520 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11521
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11522 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11523 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11524 to a vector of the characters in it.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11525
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11526 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11527 of a string. You call it as follows:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11528
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11529 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11530
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11531 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11532 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11533 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11534 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11535 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11536
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11537 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11538 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11539
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11540 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11541 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11542
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11543 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11544 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11545 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11546 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11547
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11548 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11549
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11550 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11551
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11552 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11553 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11554 are not included in the resulting value.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11555
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11556 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11557 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11558 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11559 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11560
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11561 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11562 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11563 character extends across that column), then the padding character
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11564 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11565 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11566 column START-COLUMN.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11567
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11568 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11569 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11570 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11571 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11572 changed text, before the change.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11573
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11574 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11575 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11576 one character set for each script, not for each language.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11577
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11578 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11579
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11580 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11581
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11582 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11583 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11584
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11585 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11586 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11587 which identify the character within that character set.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11588
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11589 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11590 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11591 opposite of split-char.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11592
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11593 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11594 of all the characters between BEG and END.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11595
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11596 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11597 of all the characters in a string.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11598
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11599 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11600 and specifying coding systems.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11601
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11602 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11603 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11604 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11605 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11606 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11607 as what to do about code conversion.)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11608
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11609 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11610 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11611
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11612 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11613 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11614 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11615
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11616 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11617 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11618 to match against a file name.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11619
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11620 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11621 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11622 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11623 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11624 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11625 specifies the coding system for encoding.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11626
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11627 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11628 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11629
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11630 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11631 the coding system to use for network sockets.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11632
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11633 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11634 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11635 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11636 service names.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11637
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11638 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11639 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11640 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11641 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11642 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11643 specifies the coding system for encoding.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11644
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11645 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11646 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11647
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11648 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11649 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11650 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11651 start the subprocess.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11652
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11653 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11654 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11655 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11656 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11657 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11658
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11659 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11660 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11661 subprocess.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11662
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11663 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11664 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11665 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11666 connection permanently or until overridden.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11667
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11668 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11669 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11670 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11671 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11672 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11673 system for one operation at a time.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11674
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11675 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11676 files, subprocesses or network connections.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11677
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11678 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11679 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11680 The value is a cons cell,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11681 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11682 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11683 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11684 input to the subprocess.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11685
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11686 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11687 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11688
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11689 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11690 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11691 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11692
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11693 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11694 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11695 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11696 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11697 customization.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11698
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11699 Thus, instead of writing
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11700
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11701 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11702 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11703
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11704 you would now write this:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11705
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11706 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11707 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11708 :type 'boolean
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11709 :group foo)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11710
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11711 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11712 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11713 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11714 for a description of them.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11715
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11716 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11717 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11718
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11719 (defgroup ispell nil
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11720 "Spell checking using Ispell."
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11721 :group 'processes)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11722
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11723 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11724 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11725 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11726 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11727 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11728
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11729 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11730 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11731 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11732 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11733 first-level subgroups.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11734
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11735 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11736
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11737 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11738 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11739
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11740 ** easy-mmode
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11741
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11742 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11743 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11744 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11745 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11746 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11747 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11748
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11749 ** Text property changes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11750
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11751 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11752 text property.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11753
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11754 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11755 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11756 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11757 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11758 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11759
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11760 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11761 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11762 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11763 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11764
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11765 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11766 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11767 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11768
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11769 ** Changes in invisibility features
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11770
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11771 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11772 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11773 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11774 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11775 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11776 make the overlay visible.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11777
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11778 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11779 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11780 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11781 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11782 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11783 t when it should hide it.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11784
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11785 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11786
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11787 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11788 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11789 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11790 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11791 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11792 Here is an example of how to do this:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11793
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11794 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11795 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11796 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11797 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11798
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11799 ...
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11800 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11801
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11802 ...
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11803 ;; When done with the overlays:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11804 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11805 ;; Or respectively:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11806 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11807
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11808 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11809
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11810 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11811 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11812 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11813 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11814
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11815 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11816 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11817 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11818
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11819 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11820 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11821
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11822 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11823 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11824
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11825 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11826 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11827 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11828
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11829 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11830 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11831 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11832 determine the syntax type of the character.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11833
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11834 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11835 of the current buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11836
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11837 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11838 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11839 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11840
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11841 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11842 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11843 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11844 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11845 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11846
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11847 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11848 text property.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11849
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11850 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11851 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11852 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11853
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11854 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11855 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11856 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11857 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11858 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11859
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11860 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11861 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11862 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11863
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11864 ** Changes in face features
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11865
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11866 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11867 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11868
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11869 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11870 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11871
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11872 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11873 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11874
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11875 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11876 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11877
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11878 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11879 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11880 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11881 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11882 overlay property).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11883
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11884 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11885 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11886
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11887 ** Changes in file-handling functions
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11888
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11889 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11890 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11891 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11892 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11893
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11894 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11895 begins with ~.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11896
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11897 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11898 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11899
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11900 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11901 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11902
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11903 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11904 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11905
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11906 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11907 character code conversion as well as other things.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11908
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11909 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11910 (formerly it did not).
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11911
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11912 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11913 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11914
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11915 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11916 instead of constant strings.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11917
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11918 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11919 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11920 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11921
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11922 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11923 in the same way as before.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11924
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11925 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11926 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11927 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11928
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11929 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11930 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11931 else, and returns nil.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11932
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11933 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11934 directory cannot be listed.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11935
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11936 ** Changes in minibuffer input
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11937
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11938 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11939 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11940 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11941 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11942 ways:
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11943
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11944 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11945 It is available through the history command M-n.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11946
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11947 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11948 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11949 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11950 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11951 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11952
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11953 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11954 argument in this way.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11955
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11956 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11957 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11958 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11959
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11960 ** Echo area features
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11961
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11962 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11963 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11964 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11965 after the echo area is cleared.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11966
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11967 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11968 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11969
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11970 ** Keyboard input features
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11971
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11972 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11973 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11974
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11975 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11976 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11977 by keyboard macros.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11978
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11979 ** Frame-related changes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11980
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11981 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11982 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11983 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11984
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11985 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11986 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11987 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11988
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11989 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11990 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11991 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11992 in the selected frame.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11993
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11994 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11995 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11996 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11997
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11998 ** X Windows features
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
11999
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12000 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12001 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12002 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12003
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12004 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12005 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12006
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12007 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12008 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12009 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12010
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12011 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12012 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12013
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12014 ** Subprocess features
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12015
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12016 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12017 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12018 automatically.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12019
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12020 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12021 and returns the output from the command as a string.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12022
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12023 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12024 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12025
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12026 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12027 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12028
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12029 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12030 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12031 goes after the other menu items.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12032
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12033 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12034 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12035 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12036 are in use.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12037
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12038 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12039 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12040
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12041 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12042 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12043 form.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12044
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12045 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12046 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12047 but its hook is still run.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12048
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12049 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12050 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12051
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12052 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12053 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12054 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12055
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12056 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12057 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12058 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12059 warned.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12060
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12061 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12062 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12063
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12064 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12065 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12066 functions like display-time.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12067
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12068 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12069 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12070
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12071 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12072 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12073 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12074
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12075 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12076 if there is an error in compilation.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12077
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12078 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12079 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12080 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12081 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12082
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12083 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12084 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12085 the *scratch* buffer.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12086
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12087 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12088 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12089 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12090 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12091
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12092 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12093 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12094 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12095
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12096 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12097 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12098 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12099 and compose-mail-other-frame.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12100
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12101 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12102 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12103 full name of the specified user will be returned.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12104
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12105 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12106 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12107 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12108 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12109 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12110 files at all.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12111
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12112 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12113 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12114 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12115 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12116
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12117 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12118 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12119 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12120 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12121
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12122 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12123
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12124 ** imenu.el changes.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12125
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12126 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12127 item from menu created by imenu.
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12128
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12129 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12130 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12131 select one of those items.
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
12132
30922
6c3081f54e62 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 30871
diff changeset
12133 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
12134
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
12135 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
12136 Copyright information:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
12137
49407
c47a7a3493da *** empty log message ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 49395
diff changeset
12138 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
12139
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
12140 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
12141 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
12142 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
12143 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
12144
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
12145 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
12146 of this document, or of portions of it,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
12147 under the above conditions, provided also that they
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
12148 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
35577
db5649648a65 Replace formfeeds removed on 2001/01/22.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 35567
diff changeset
12149
25853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
12150 Local variables:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
12151 mode: outline
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
12152 paragraph-separate: "[ ]*$"
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
12153 end: